Piccolo™ Microcontrollers TMS320F28030, TMS320F28033, 1

TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Piccolo™ Microcontrollers
Check for Samples: TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032, TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
1 TMS320F2803x (Piccolo) MCUs
1.1
Features
1234
• High-Efficiency 32-Bit CPU ( TMS320C28x™)
– 60 MHz (16.67-ns Cycle Time)
– 16 x 16 and 32 x 32 MAC Operations
– 16 x 16 Dual MAC
– Harvard Bus Architecture
– Atomic Operations
– Fast Interrupt Response and Processing
– Unified Memory Programming Model
– Code-Efficient (in C/C++ and Assembly)
• Programmable Control Law Accelerator (CLA)
– 32-Bit Floating-Point Math Accelerator
– Executes Code Independently of the Main
CPU
• Endianness: Little Endian
• JTAG Boundary Scan Support (1)
• Low Cost for Both Device and System:
– Single 3.3-V Supply
– No Power Sequencing Requirement
– Integrated Power-on Reset and Brown-out
Reset
– Low Power
– No Analog Support Pins
• Clocking:
– Two Internal Zero-pin Oscillators
– On-Chip Crystal Oscillator/External Clock
Input
– Dynamic PLL Ratio Changes Supported
– Watchdog Timer Module
– Missing Clock Detection Circuitry
• Up to 45 Individually Programmable,
Multiplexed GPIO Pins With Input Filtering
• Peripheral Interrupt Expansion (PIE) Block That
Supports All Peripheral Interrupts
• Three 32-Bit CPU Timers
• Independent 16-Bit Timer in Each ePWM
Module
• On-Chip Memory
– Flash, SARAM, OTP, Boot ROM Available
• Code-Security Module
• 128-Bit Security Key/Lock
– Protects Secure Memory Blocks
– Prevents Firmware Reverse Engineering
• Serial Port Peripherals
– One SCI (UART) Module
– Two SPI Modules
– One Inter-Integrated-Circuit (I2C) Bus
– One Local Interconnect Network (LIN) Bus
– One Enhanced Controller Area Network
(eCAN) Bus
• Enhanced Control Peripherals
– Enhanced Pulse Width Modulator (ePWM)
– High-Resolution PWM (HRPWM) Module
– Enhanced Capture (eCAP) Module
– High-Resolution Input Capture (HRCAP)
Module
– Enhanced Quadrature Encoder Pulse (eQEP)
Module
– Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
– On-Chip Temperature Sensor
– Comparator
• Advanced Emulation Features
– Analysis and Breakpoint Functions
– Real-Time Debug via Hardware
• 2803x Packages
– 56-Pin RSH Very Small Quad Flatpack
(No Lead) (VQFN)
– 64-Pin PAG Thin Quad Flatpack (TQFP)
– 80-Pin PN Low-Profile Quad Flatpack (LQFP)
(1)
IEEE Standard 1149.1-1990 Standard Test Access Port and
Boundary Scan Architecture
Please be aware that an important notice concerning availability, standard warranty, and use in critical applications of
Texas Instruments semiconductor products and disclaimers thereto appears at the end of this data sheet.
Piccolo, TMS320C28x, C28x, TMS320C2000, Code Composer Studio, XDS510, XDS560 are trademarks of Texas
Instruments.
I2C-bus is a registered trademark of NXP B.V. Corporation.
All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.
1
2
3
4
UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED this document contains PRODUCTION DATA information
current as of publication date. Products conform to specifications per the terms of Texas
Instruments standard warranty. Production processing does not necessarily include
testing of all parameters.
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
1.2
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
www.ti.com
Applications
Smart Grid and Power Line Communications
White Goods
Switch Mode Power Supplies (SMPSs)
DC-DC Multiple-Output Power Supplies
Solar Micro Inverters and Converters
Power Factor Correction
Sewing and Textile Machines
AC-DC Inverters
1.3
Description
The F2803x Piccolo family of microcontrollers provides the power of the C28x™ core and Control Law
Accelerator (CLA) coupled with highly integrated control peripherals in low pin-count devices. This family
is code-compatible with previous C28x-based code, as well as providing a high level of analog integration.
An internal voltage regulator allows for single-rail operation. Enhancements have been made to the
HRPWM module to allow for dual-edge control (frequency modulation). Analog comparators with internal
10-bit references have been added and can be routed directly to control the PWM outputs. The ADC
converts from 0 to 3.3-V fixed full-scale range and supports ratio-metric VREFHI/VREFLO references. The
ADC interface has been optimized for low overhead and latency.
2
TMS320F2803x (Piccolo) MCUs
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
1.4
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Functional Block Diagram
Figure 1-1 shows the functional block diagram for the device.
Memory Bus
M0
SARAM 1Kx16
(0-wait)
M1
SARAM 1Kx16
(0-wait)
OTP 1K x 16
Secure
SARAM
4K/6K/8K x 16
(CLA Only on
28033 and 28035)
(0-wait)
Secure
Code
Security
Module
Boot-ROM
8Kx16
(0-wait)
FLASH
16K/32K/64K x 16
Secure
OTP/Flash
Wrapper
PSWD
CLA Bus
Memory Bus
CLA
TRST
COMP1A
COMP1B
COMP2A
COMP2B
COMP3A
COMP3B
COMP
C28x
32-bit CPU
3 External Interrupts
PIE
CPU Timer 0
AIO
CPU Timer 1
MUX
CPU Timer 2
GPIO
Mux
XCLKIN
X1
X2
LPM Wakeup
OSC1,
OSC2,
Ext,
PLL,
LPM,
WD
XRS
ADC
A7:0
Memory Bus
POR/
BOR
B7:0
32-bit Peripheral Bus
(CLA accessible)
LIN
eCAP
eQEP
EQE PxI
EQEPxS
EQ EPxB
EQ EPxA
ECA Px
LINA T X
From
COMP1OUT,
COMP2OUT,
COMP3OUT
L IN A RX
EPWMSYNCO
EPW MxB
TZx
HRPWM
EPW MxA
SC L x
SDA x
SPIC LK x
eCAN
(32-mail
box)
ePWM
I C
(4L FIFO)
SPISTEx
SPISOMIx
32-Bit Peripheral Bus
HRCAP
HRCAPx
2
SPI
(4L FIFO)
SPISIMO x
SCIR XDx
SC IT XD x
SCI
(4L FIFO)
EPWMSYNCI
16-bit Peripheral Bus
VREG
CA N TXx
MUX
TCK
TDI
TMS
TDO
C AN R Xx
GPIO
32-bit peripheral bus
(CLA-accessible)
COMP1OUT
COMP2OUT
COMP3OUT
GPIO MUX
A.
Not all peripheral pins are available at the same time due to multiplexing.
Figure 1-1. Functional Block Diagram
1.5
Getting Started
This section gives a brief overview of the steps to take when first developing for a C28x device. For more
detail on each of these steps, see the following:
• Getting Started With TMS320C28x Digital Signal Controllers (literature number SPRAAM0).
• C2000 Getting Started Website (http://www.ti.com/c2000getstarted)
• TMS320F28x MCU Development and Experimenter's Kits (http://www.ti.com/f28xkits)
TMS320F2803x (Piccolo) MCUs
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
3
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
...................... 1
............................................. 1
1.2
Applications .......................................... 2
1.3
Description ........................................... 2
1.4
Functional Block Diagram ........................... 3
1.5
Getting Started ....................................... 3
Revision History .............................................. 5
2 Introduction .............................................. 7
2.1
Pin Assignments .................................... 10
2.2
Signal Descriptions ................................. 14
3 Functional Overview .................................. 22
3.1
Memory Maps ...................................... 22
3.2
Brief Descriptions ................................... 29
3.3
Register Map ....................................... 38
3.4
Device Emulation Registers ........................ 40
3.5
Interrupts ............................................ 41
3.6
VREG/BOR/POR ................................... 45
3.7
System Control ..................................... 47
3.8
Low-power Modes Block ........................... 55
4 Peripherals .............................................. 56
4.1
Control Law Accelerator (CLA) Overview .......... 56
4.2
Analog Block ........................................ 59
4.3
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Module ........... 65
4.4
Serial Communications Interface (SCI) Module .... 68
4.5
Local Interconnect Network (LIN) .................. 71
1
TMS320F2803x (Piccolo) MCUs
1.1
4.6
4.7
4
Features
5
6
Contents
74
78
Enhanced PWM Modules (ePWM1/2/3/4/5/6/7)
4.9
High-Resolution PWM (HRPWM)
5.1
Device and Development Support Tool
Nomenclature ..................................... 100
...........................
............................
Electrical Specifications ............................
6.1
Absolute Maximum Ratings .......................
6.2
Recommended Operating Conditions .............
6.3
Electrical Characteristics ..........................
6.4
Current Consumption .............................
6.5
Thermal Design Considerations ..................
5.2
Related Documentation
5.3
Community Resources
6.6
Enhanced Controller Area Network (eCAN) Module
......................................................
Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) ........................
... 80
.................. 87
4.10 Enhanced Capture Module (eCAP1) ............... 88
4.11 High-Resolution Capture (HRCAP) Module ........ 90
4.12 Enhanced Quadrature Encoder Pulse (eQEP) ..... 92
4.13 JTAG Port .......................................... 94
4.14 GPIO MUX ......................................... 95
Device Support ....................................... 100
4.8
7
102
104
105
105
105
106
107
111
Emulator Connection Without Signal Buffering for
the MCU ........................................... 111
.....................
.........
6.9
Power Sequencing ................................
6.10 General-Purpose Input/Output (GPIO) ............
6.11 Enhanced Control Peripherals ....................
6.12 Detailed Descriptions .............................
6.13 Flash Timing ......................................
Thermal/Mechanical Data ..........................
6.7
Timing Parameter Symbology
112
6.8
Clock Requirements and Characteristics
115
116
118
125
144
145
147
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Revision History
NOTE: Page numbers for previous revisions may differ from page numbers in the current version.
This data manual revision history highlights the technical changes made to the SPRS584I device-specific
data manual to make it an SPRS584J revision.
Scope: See table below.
LOCATION
Section 1
Section 1.1
ADDITIONS, DELETIONS, AND MODIFICATIONS
TMS320F2803x ( Piccolo™) MCUs:
•
Added Section 1.2, Applications
Features:
•
Restructured Features section. Removed "Highlights". Integrated "Highlights" features with rest of
Features list.
•
Added "JTAG Boundary Scan Support" feature
•
Added "IEEE Standard 1149.1-1990 Standard Test Access Port and Boundary Scan Architecture"
footnote
Moved Functional Block Diagram from Section 3 to Section 1
Table 2-1
Hardware Features:
•
Changed "ePWM outputs" to "ePWM channels"
Table 2-2
Terminal Functions:
•
PN Pin 76, GPIO13: Changed order of muxed signals
•
PN Pin 80, GPIO24: Changed order of muxed signals
•
PN Pin 44, GPIO25: Changed order of muxed signals
•
PN Pin 37, GPIO26: Changed order of muxed signals
•
PN Pin 31, GPIO27: Changed order of muxed signals
•
PN Pin 74, GPIO34: Changed order of muxed signals
•
PN Pin 5, GPIO42: Changed order of muxed signals
•
PN Pin 6, GPIO43: Changed order of muxed signals
Section 3.2.5
Real-Time JTAG and Analysis:
•
Removed "These devices do not support boundary scan; however, IDCODE and BYPASS features are
available if the following considerations are taken into account. The IDCODE does not come by default.
The user needs to go through a sequence of SHIFT IR and SHIFT DR state of JTAG to get the
IDCODE. For BYPASS instruction, the first shifted DR value would be 1."
Section 3.2.10
Security:
•
"In addition to the CSM, ..." paragraph:
– Changed "Any code or data access to flash, user OTP, or L0 memory while the emulator is
connected ..." to "Any code or data access to CSM secure memory while the emulator is
connected ..."
Section 3.2.11
Peripheral Interrupt Expansion (PIE) Block:
•
Changed "On the F2803x, 54 of the possible 96 interrupts are used by peripherals" to "On the F2803x,
56 of the possible 96 interrupts are used by peripherals"
Section 4.1
Control Law Accelerator (CLA) Overview:
•
Added reference to TMS320x2803x Piccolo Control Law Accelerator (CLA) Reference Guide (literature
number SPRUGE6)
Section 4.2
Analog Block:
•
Added reference to TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) and Comparator
Reference Guide (literature number SPRUGE5)
Section 4.2.1.1
Features:
•
Removed "Runs at full system clock, no prescaling required" from "Functions of the ADC module" list
Section 4.3
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Module:
•
Added reference to TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Reference Guide
(literature number SPRUG71)
Section 4.4
Serial Communications Interface (SCI) Module:
•
Added reference to TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Serial Communications Interface (SCI) Reference
Guide (literature number SPRUGH1)
Contents
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
5
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
LOCATION
6
www.ti.com
ADDITIONS, DELETIONS, AND MODIFICATIONS
Section 4.5
Local Interconnect Network (LIN):
•
Added reference to TMS320F2803x Piccolo Local Interconnect Network (LIN) Module User's Guide
(literature number SPRUGE2)
Section 4.6
Enhanced Controller Area Network (eCAN) Module:
•
Added reference to TMS320x2803x Piccolo Enhanced Controller Area Network (eCAN) Reference
Guide (literature number SPRUGL7)
Section 4.7
Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C):
•
Added reference to TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Module Reference
Guide (literature number SPRUFZ9)
Section 4.9
High-Resolution PWM (HRPWM):
•
Added reference to TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo High Resolution Pulse Width Modulator (HRPWM)
Reference Guide (literature number SPRUGE8)
Section 4.10
Enhanced Capture Module (eCAP1):
•
Added reference to TMS320F2802x, 2803x Piccolo Enhanced Capture (eCAP) Module Reference
Guide (literature number SPRUFZ8)
Section 4.11
High-Resolution Capture (HRCAP) Module:
•
Revised "The HRCAP module includes one capture channel in addition to a high-resolution calibration
block ..." paragraph
•
Added reference to TMS320x2803x Piccolo High Resolution Capture (HRCAP) Reference Guide
(literature number SPRUH56)
Section 4.12
Enhanced Quadrature Encoder Pulse (eQEP):
•
Added reference to TMS320x2803x Piccolo Enhanced Quadrature Encoder Pulse (eQEP) Module
Reference Guide (literature number SPRUFK8)
Section 6.9
Power Sequencing:
•
Removed "Furthermore, VDDIO and VDDA should always be within 0.3 V of each other" sentence from
"There is no power sequencing requirement needed ..." paragraph
Table 6-22
High-Resolution PWM Characteristics:
•
Updated footnote about maximum MEP step size: Changed "Maximum MEP step size is based on
worst-case process, maximum temperature and maximum voltage" to "Maximum MEP step size is
based on worst-case process, maximum temperature and minimum voltage"
Table 6-44
Flash Parameters at 60-MHz SYSCLKOUT:
•
Updated "Typical parameters as seen at room temperature ..." footnote
Contents
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
2 Introduction
Table 2-1 lists the features of the TMS320F2803x devices.
Introduction
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
7
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Table 2-1. Hardware Features
FEATURE
28030
(60 MHz)
TYPE (1)
80-Pin
PN
LQFP
Package Type
64-Pin
PAG
TQFP
28031
(60 MHz)
56-Pin
RSH
VQFN
80-Pin
PN
LQFP
64-Pin
PAG
TQFP
28032
(60 MHz)
56-Pin
RSH
VQFN
80-Pin
PN
LQFP
64-Pin
PAG
TQFP
28033
(60 MHz)
56-Pin
RSH
VQFN
80-Pin
PN
LQFP
64-Pin
PAG
TQFP
28034
(60 MHz)
56-Pin
RSH
VQFN
80-Pin
PN
LQFP
64-Pin
PAG
TQFP
28035
(60 MHz)
56-Pin
RSH
VQFN
80-Pin
PN
LQFP
64-Pin
PAG
TQFP
Instruction cycle
–
16.67 ns
16.67 ns
16.67 ns
16.67 ns
16.67 ns
Control Law Accelerator
0
No
No
No
Yes
No
Yes
On-chip flash (16-bit word)
–
16K
32K
32K
32K
64K
64K
On-chip SARAM (16-bit word)
–
6K
8K
10K
10K
10K
10K
Code security for on-chip
flash/SARAM/OTP blocks
–
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Boot ROM (8K x 16)
–
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
One-time programmable (OTP) ROM
(16-bit word)
–
1K
1K
1K
1K
1K
1K
ePWM channels
1
eCAP inputs
0
eQEP modules
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
Watchdog timer
–
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
14
Conversion Time
Channels
3
8
14
1
MSPS
12-Bit ADC
12
16
Temperature Sensor
Dual Sample-and-Hold
12
8
14
1
12
8
14
1
12
8
14
1
12
16.67 ns
8
14
1
12
2.0
2.0
4.6
4.6
4.6
4.6
500.00 ns
216.67 ns
216.67 ns
216.67 ns
216.67 ns
13
16
14
13
16
14
13
16
14
13
16
14
8
1
500.00 ns
14
56-Pin
RSH
VQFN
13
16
14
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
13
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
32-Bit CPU timers
–
3
3
3
3
3
High-resolution ePWM Channels
1
–
–
7
6
4
7
6
4
7
6
4
7
6
4
High-resolution Capture (HRCAP)
Modules
0
–
–
2
2
–
2
2
–
2
2
–
2
2
–
Comparators with Integrated DACs
0
3
3
3
3
3
3
Inter-integrated circuit (I2C)
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
Enhanced Controller Area Network
(eCAN)
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
Local Interconnect Network (LIN)
0
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
1
Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
0
GPIO
–
AIO
–
I/O pins
(shared)
1
2
1
1
1
2
1
45
33
6
1
1
1
2
1
26
45
33
6
1
1
1
2
1
26
45
33
6
1
1
1
2
1
26
45
33
3
1
1
1
2
1
26
45
6
33
6
1
26
45
33
–
3
3
3
3
3
3
Supply voltage (nominal)
–
3.3 V
3.3 V
3.3 V
3.3 V
3.3 V
3.3 V
8
26
6
External interrupts
(1)
1
1
A type change represents a major functional feature difference in a peripheral module. Within a peripheral type, there may be minor differences between devices that do not affect the
basic functionality of the module. These device-specific differences are listed in the TMS320x28xx, 28xxx DSP Peripheral Reference Guide (literature number SPRU566) and in the
peripheral reference guides.
Introduction
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 2-1. Hardware Features (continued)
FEATURE
TYPE
80-Pin
PN
LQFP
Package Type
Temperature
options
Product status (2)
(1)
(2)
28030
(60 MHz)
(1)
64-Pin
PAG
TQFP
28031
(60 MHz)
56-Pin
RSH
VQFN
80-Pin
PN
LQFP
64-Pin
PAG
TQFP
28032
(60 MHz)
56-Pin
RSH
VQFN
80-Pin
PN
LQFP
64-Pin
PAG
TQFP
28033
(60 MHz)
56-Pin
RSH
VQFN
80-Pin
PN
LQFP
64-Pin
PAG
TQFP
28034
(60 MHz)
56-Pin
RSH
VQFN
80-Pin
PN
LQFP
64-Pin
PAG
TQFP
T: –40°C to 105°C
–
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
S: –40°C to 125°C
–
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Q: –40°C to 125°C (1)
–
–
Yes
TMS
No
TMS
TMX
Yes
TMS
No
TMS
TMX
Yes
TMS
No
TMS
TMX
Yes
TMS
No
TMS
TMX
Yes
TMS
28035
(60 MHz)
56-Pin
RSH
VQFN
80-Pin
PN
LQFP
56-Pin
RSH
VQFN
Yes
Yes
No
TMS
64-Pin
PAG
TQFP
TMX
Yes
TMS
No
TMS
TMX
"Q" refers to Q100 qualification for automotive applications.
See Section 5.1, Device and Development Support Tool Nomenclature, for descriptions of device stages. The "TMS" product status denotes a fully qualified production device. The "TMX"
product status denotes an experimental device that is not necessarily representative of the final device's electrical specifications.
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Introduction
9
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
2.1
www.ti.com
Pin Assignments
Figure 2-1 shows the 56-pin RSH Very Small Quad Flatpack (No Lead) (VQFN) pin assignments.
Figure 2-2 shows the 64-pin PAG Thin Quad Flatpack (TQFP) pin assignments. Figure 2-3 shows the 80pin PN Low-Profile Quad Flatpack (LQFP) pin assignments.
NOTE
Information/data on the 56-pin RSH package is "TMX". The "TMX" product status denotes an
experimental device that is not necessarily representative of the final device's electrical
specifications. See Section 5.1, Device and Development Support Tool Nomenclature, for
descriptions of device stages.
10
Introduction
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
GPIO35/TDI
GPIO37/TDO
GPIO38/TCK/XCLKIN
GPIO19/XCLKIN/SPISTEA/LINRXA/ECAP1
VDD
VSS
X1
X2
GPIO6/EPWM4A/EPWMSYNCI/EPWMSYNCO
GPIO7/EPWM4B/SCIRXDA
GPIO12/TZ1/SCITXDA
GPIO16/SPISIMOA/TZ2
GPIO17/SPISOMIA/TZ3
GPIO18/SPICLKA/LINTXA/XCLKOUT
www.ti.com
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
GPIO28/SCIRXDA/SDAA/TZ2
TEST2
VDDIO
VSS
GPIO29/SCITXDA/SCLA/TZ3
GPIO30/CANRXA
GPIO31/CANTXA
ADCINB7
ADCINB6/COMP3B/AIO14
ADCINB4/COMP2B/AIO12
ADCINB3
ADCINB2/COMP1B/AIO10
ADCINB1
VSSA/VREFLO
GPIO22/EQEP1S/LINTXA 1
GPIO23/EQEP1I/LINRXA 2
VDD 3
VSS 4
XRS 5
TRST 6
ADCINA7 7
ADCINA6/COMP3A/AIO6 8
ADCINA4/COMP2A/AIO4 9
ADCINA3 10
ADCINA2/COMP1A/AIO2 11
ADCINA1 12
ADCINA0/VREFHI 13
VDDA 14
GPIO36/TMS
GPIO5/EPWM3B/SPISIMOA/ECAP1
GPIO4/EPWM3A
GPIO3/EPWM2B/SPISOMIA/COMP2OUT
GPIO2/EPWM2A
GPIO1/EPWM1B/COMP1OUT
GPIO0/EPWM1A
VDDIO
VSS
VDD
VREGENZ
GPIO34/COMP2OUT/COMP3OUT
GPIO20/EQEP1A/COMP1OUT
GPIO21/EQEP1B/COMP2OUT
A.
B.
C.
This figure shows the top view of the 56-pin RSH package. Shading denotes that the terminals are actually on the
bottom side of the package. See Section 7, Thermal/Mechanical Data, for the 56-pin RSH mechanical drawing.
Pin 13: VREFHI and ADCINA0 share the same pin on the 56-pin RSH device and their use is mutually exclusive to one
another.
Pin 15: VREFLO is always connected to VSSA on the 56-pin RSH device.
Figure 2-1. 2803x 56-Pin RSH VQFN (Top View)
Introduction
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
11
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
GPIO28/SCIRXDA/SDAA/TZ2
GPIO9/EPWM5B/LINTXA/HRCAP1
TEST2
VDDIO
VSS
GPIO29/SCITXDA/SCLA/TZ3
GPIO30/CANRXA
GPIO31/CANTXA
ADCINB7
ADCINB6/COMP3B/AIO14
ADCINB4/COMP2B/AIO12
ADCINB3
ADCINB2/COMP1B/AIO10
ADCINB1
ADCINB0
VSSA/VREFLO
A.
B.
VDDA
ADCINA7
ADCINA6/COMP3A/AIO6
ADCINA4/COMP2A/AIO4
ADCINA3
ADCINA2/COMP1A/AIO2
ADCINA1
ADCINA0/VREFHI
GPIO22/EQEP1S/LINTXA
GPIO32/SDAA/EPWMSYNCI/ADCSOCAO
GPIO33/SCLA/EPWMSYNCO/ADCSOCBO
GPIO23/EQEP1I/LINRXA
VDD
VSS
XRS
TRST
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
GPIO11/EPWM6B/LINRXA/HRCAP2
GPIO5/EPWM3B/SPSIMOA/ECAP1
GPIO4/EPWM3A
GPIO10/EPWM6A/ADCSOCBO
GPIO3/EPWM2B/SPISOMIA/COMP2OUT
GPIO2/EPWM2A
GPIO1/EPWM1B/COMP1OUT
GPIO0/EPWM1A
VDDIO
VSS
VDD
VREGENZ
GPIO34/COMP2OUT/COMP3OUT
GPIO20/EQEP1A/COMP1OUT
GPIO21/EQEP1B/COMP2OUT
GPIO24/ECAP1
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
GPIO36/TMS
GPIO35/TDI
GPIO37/TDO
GPIO38/TCK/XCLKIN
GPIO19/XCLKIN/SPISTEA/LINRXA/ECAP1
VDD
VSS
X1
X2
GPIO6/EPWM4A/EPWMSYNCI/EPWMSYNCO
GPIO7/EPWM4B/SCIRXDA
GPIO12/TZ1/SCITXDA
GPIO16/SPISIMOA/TZ2
GPIO8/EPWM5A/ADCSOCAO
GPIO17/SPISOMIA/TZ3
GPIO18/SPICLKA/LINTXA/XCLKOUT
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Pin 15: VREFHI and ADCINA0 share the same pin on the 64-pin PAG device and their use is mutually exclusive to one
another.
Pin 17: VREFLO is always connected to VSSA on the 64-pin PAG device.
Figure 2-2. 2803x 64-Pin PAG TQFP (Top View)
12
Introduction
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
GPIO8/EPWM5A/ADCSOCAO
GPIO17/SPISOMIA/TZ3
GPIO18/SPICLKA/LINTXA/XCLKOUT
43
42
41
GPIO44
GPIO25/SPISOMIB
46
44
GPIO16/SPISIMOA/TZ2
47
45
GPIO41/EPWM7B
GPIO12/TZ1/SCITXDA/SPISIMOB
48
GPIO6/EPWM4A/EPWMSYNCI/EPWMSYNCO
GPIO7/EPWM4B/SCIRXDA
50
49
X1
X2
VSS
51
VDD
54
53
52
GPIO39
GPIO19/XCLKIN/SPISTEA/LINRXA/ECAP1
56
57
55
GPIO37/TDO
GPIO38/TCK/XCLKIN
58
GPIO36/TMS
GPIO35/TDI
60
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
59
www.ti.com
GPIO11/EPWM6B/LINRXA/HRCAP2
61
40
GPIO28/SCIRXDA/SDAA/TZ2
GPIO5/EPWM3B/SPISIMOA/ECAP1
62
39
GPIO9/EPWM5B/LINTXA/HRCAP1
GPIO4/EPWM3A
63
38
TEST2
GPIO40/EPWM7A
64
37
GPIO26/HRCAP1/SPICLKB
GPIO10/EPWM6A/ADCSOCBO
65
36
VDDIO
GPIO3/EPWM2B/SPISOMIA/COMP2OUT
66
35
VSS
GPIO2/EPWM2A
67
34
GPIO29/SCITXDA/SCLA/TZ3
GPIO1/EPWM1B/COMP1OUT
68
33
GPIO30/CANRXA
GPIO0/EPWM1A
69
32
GPIO31/CANTXA
VDDIO
70
31
GPIO27/HRCAP2/SPISTEB
18
19
20
VREFHI
VDDA
17
ADCINA1
ADCINA0
15
16
ADCINA3
ADCINA2/COMP1A/AIO2
VSSA
13
21
14
80
ADCINA5
VREFLO
GPIO24/ECAP1/SPISIMOB
ADCINA4/COMP2A/AIO4
22
11
79
12
ADCINB0
GPIO21/EQEP1B/COMP2OUT
ADCINA7
23
ADCINA6/COMP3A/AIO6
78
10
ADCINB1
GPIO20/EQEP1A/COMP1OUT
TRST
24
9
77
XRS
ADCINB2/COMP1B/AIO10
GPIO14/TZ3/LINTXA/SPICLKB
7
25
8
76
VSS
ADCINB3
GPIO13/TZ2/SPISOMIB
VDD
26
5
75
6
ADCINB4/COMP2B/AIO12
GPIO15/TZ1/LINRXA/SPISTEB
GPIO42/COMP1OUT
27
GPIO43/COMP2OUT
74
3
ADCINB5
GPIO34/COMP2OUT/COMP3OUT
4
28
GPIO23/EQEP1I/LINRXA
73
GPIO33/SCLA/EPWMSYNCO/ADCSOCBO
ADCINB6/COMP3B/AIO14
VREGENZ
1
ADCINB7
29
2
30
72
GPIO22/EQEP1S/LINTXA
71
GPIO32/SDAA/EPWMSYNCI/ADCSOCAO
VSS
VDD
Figure 2-3. 2803x 80-Pin PN LQFP (Top View)
Introduction
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
13
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
2.2
www.ti.com
Signal Descriptions
Table 2-2 describes the signals. With the exception of the JTAG pins, the GPIO function is the default at
reset, unless otherwise mentioned. The peripheral signals that are listed under them are alternate
functions. Some peripheral functions may not be available in all devices. See Table 2-1 for details. Inputs
are not 5-V tolerant. All GPIO pins are I/O/Z and have an internal pullup, which can be selectively
enabled/disabled on a per-pin basis. This feature only applies to the GPIO pins. The pullups on the PWM
pins are not enabled at reset. The pullups on other GPIO pins are enabled upon reset. The AIO pins do
not have an internal pullup.
NOTE: When the on-chip VREG is used, the GPIO19, GPIO34, GPIO35, GPIO36, GPIO37, and GPIO38
pins could glitch during power up. If this is unacceptable in an application, 1.8 V could be supplied
externally. There is no power-sequencing requirement when using an external 1.8-V supply. However, if
the 3.3-V transistors in the level-shifting output buffers of the I/O pins are powered prior to the 1.9-V
transistors, it is possible for the output buffers to turn on, causing a glitch to occur on the pin during power
up. To avoid this behavior, power the VDD pins prior to or simultaneously with the VDDIO pins, ensuring that
the VDD pins have reached 0.7 V before the VDDIO pins reach 0.7 V.
Table 2-2. Terminal Functions (1)
TERMINAL
NAME
PN
PIN #
PAG
PIN #
RSH
PIN #
I/O/Z
DESCRIPTION
JTAG
TRST
10
8
6
I
JTAG test reset with internal pulldown. TRST, when driven high, gives the scan
system control of the operations of the device. If this signal is not connected or
driven low, the device operates in its functional mode, and the test reset signals
are ignored. NOTE: TRST is an active high test pin and must be maintained low
at all times during normal device operation. An external pull-down resistor is
required on this pin. The value of this resistor should be based on drive strength
of the debugger pods applicable to the design. A 2.2-kΩ resistor generally offers
adequate protection. Since this is application-specific, it is recommended that
each target board be validated for proper operation of the debugger and the
application. (↓)
TCK
See GPIO38
I
See GPIO38. JTAG test clock with internal pullup. (↑)
TMS
See GPIO36
I
See GPIO36. JTAG test-mode select (TMS) with internal pullup. This serial
control input is clocked into the TAP controller on the rising edge of TCK.. (↑)
TDI
See GPIO35
I
See GPIO35. JTAG test data input (TDI) with internal pullup. TDI is clocked into
the selected register (instruction or data) on a rising edge of TCK. (↑)
TDO
See GPIO37
O/Z
See GPIO37. JTAG scan out, test data output (TDO). The contents of the
selected register (instruction or data) are shifted out of TDO on the falling edge of
TCK. (8 mA drive)
I/O
Test Pin. Reserved for TI. Must be left unconnected.
FLASH
TEST2
(1)
14
38
30
27
I = Input, O = Output, Z = High Impedance, OD = Open Drain, ↑ = Pullup, ↓ = Pulldown
Introduction
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 2-2. Terminal Functions(1) (continued)
TERMINAL
NAME
PN
PIN #
PAG
PIN #
RSH
PIN #
I/O/Z
DESCRIPTION
O/Z
See GPIO18. Output clock derived from SYSCLKOUT. XCLKOUT is either the
same frequency, one-half the frequency, or one-fourth the frequency of
SYSCLKOUT. This is controlled by bits 1:0 (XCLKOUTDIV) in the XCLK register.
At reset, XCLKOUT = SYSCLKOUT/4. The XCLKOUT signal can be turned off by
setting XCLKOUTDIV to 3. The mux control for GPIO18 must also be set to
XCLKOUT for this signal to propogate to the pin.
I
See GPIO19 and GPIO38. External oscillator input. Pin source for the clock is
controlled by the XCLKINSEL bit in the XCLK register, GPIO38 is the default
selection. This pin feeds a clock from an external 3.3-V oscillator. In this case, the
X1 pin, if available, must be tied to GND and the on-chip crystal oscillator must be
disabled via bit 14 in the CLKCTL register. If a crystal/resonator is used, the
XCLKIN path must be disabled by bit 13 in the CLKCTL register.
NOTE: Designs that use the GPIO38/TCK/XCLKIN pin to supply an external clock
for normal device operation may need to incorporate some hooks to disable this
path during debug using the JTAG connector. This is to prevent contention with
the TCK signal, which is active during JTAG debug sessions. The zero-pin
internal oscillators may be used during this time to clock the device.
CLOCK
XCLKOUT
XCLKIN
See GPIO18
–
See GPIO19 and GPIO38
X1
52
41
36
I
On-chip crystal-oscillator input. To use this oscillator, a quartz crystal or a ceramic
resonator must be connected across X1 and X2. In this case, the XCLKIN path
must be disabled by bit 13 in the CLKCTL register. If this pin is not used, it must
be tied to GND. (I)
X2
51
40
35
O
On-chip crystal-oscillator output. A quartz crystal or a ceramic resonator must be
connected across X1 and X2. If X2 is not used, it must be left unconnected. (O)
RESET
I/O
Device Reset (in) and Watchdog Reset (out). Piccolo devices have a built-in
power-on-reset (POR) and brown-out-reset (BOR) circuitry. As such, no external
circuitry is needed to generate a reset pulse. During a power-on or brown-out
condition, this pin is driven low by the device. See Section 6.3, Electrical
Characteristics, for thresholds of the POR/BOR block. This pin is also driven low
by the MCU when a watchdog reset occurs. During watchdog reset, the XRS pin
is driven low for the watchdog reset duration of 512 OSCCLK cycles. If need be,
an external circuitry may also drive this pin to assert a device reset. In this case, it
is recommended that this pin be driven by an open-drain device. An R-C circuit
must be connected to this pin for noise immunity reasons. Regardless of the
source, a device reset causes the device to terminate execution. The program
counter points to the address contained at the location 0x3FFFC0. When reset is
deactivated, execution begins at the location designated by the program counter.
The output buffer of this pin is an open-drain with an internal pullup. (I/OD)
XRS
9
7
5
ADCINA7
11
9
7
I
ADC Group A, Channel 7 input
ADCINA6
12
10
8
I
ADC Group A, Channel 6 input
I
Comparator Input 3A
ADC, COMPARATOR, ANALOG I/O
COMP3A
AIO6
I/O
Digital AIO 6
ADCINA5
13
–
–
I
ADC Group A, Channel 5 input
ADCINA4
14
11
9
I
ADC Group A, Channel 4 input
I
Comparator Input 2A
COMP2A
AIO4
I/O
Digital AIO 4
ADCINA3
15
12
10
I
ADC Group A, Channel 3 input
ADCINA2
16
13
11
I
ADC Group A, Channel 2 input
I
Comparator Input 1A
COMP1A
AIO2
I/O
Digital AIO 2
Introduction
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
15
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Table 2-2. Terminal Functions(1) (continued)
TERMINAL
NAME
PN
PIN #
PAG
PIN #
RSH
PIN #
I/O/Z
17
14
12
I
ADC Group A, Channel 1 input
I
ADC Group A, Channel 0 input.
NOTE: VREFHI and ADCINA0 share the same pin on the 64-pin PAG device and
their use is mutually exclusive to one another.
NOTE: VREFHI and ADCINA0 share the same pin on the 56-pin RSH device and
their use is mutually exclusive to one another.
ADCINA1
ADCINA0
18
15
13
DESCRIPTION
VREFHI
19
15
13
I
ADC External Reference – only used when in ADC external reference mode. See
Section 4.2.1, ADC.
NOTE: VREFHI and ADCINA0 share the same pin on the 64-pin PAG device and
their use is mutually exclusive to one another.
NOTE: VREFHI and ADCINA0 share the same pin on the 56-pin RSH device and
their use is mutually exclusive to one another.
ADCINB7
30
24
21
I
ADC Group B, Channel 7 input
ADCINB6
29
23
20
I
ADC Group B, Channel 6 input
I
Comparator Input 3B
COMP3B
AIO14
I/O
Digital AIO 14
ADCINB5
28
–
–
I
ADC Group B, Channel 5 input
ADCINB4
27
22
19
I
ADC Group B, Channel 4 input
I
Comparator Input 2B
COMP2B
AIO12
I/O
Digital AIO12
ADCINB3
26
21
18
I
ADC Group B, Channel 3 input
ADCINB2
25
20
17
I
ADC Group B, Channel 2 input
I
Comparator Input 1B
COMP1B
AIO10
I/O
Digital AIO 10
ADCINB1
24
19
16
I
ADC Group B, Channel 1 input
ADCINB0
23
18
–
I
ADC Group B, Channel 0 input
VREFLO
22
17
15
I
NOTE: VREFLO is always connected to VSSA on the 64-pin PAG device and on the
56-pin RSH device.
VDDA
20
16
14
Analog Power Pin. Tie with a 2.2-μF capacitor (typical) close to the pin.
VSSA
21
17
15
Analog Ground Pin.
NOTE: VREFLO is always connected to VSSA on the 64-pin PAG device and on the
56-pin RSH device.
VDD
7
5
3
VDD
54
43
38
VDD
72
59
52
VDDIO
36
29
26
VDDIO
70
57
50
CPU AND I/O POWER
VSS
8
6
4
VSS
35
28
25
VSS
53
42
37
VSS
71
58
51
16
Introduction
CPU and Logic Digital Power Pins – no supply source needed when using
internal VREG. Tie with 1.2 µF (minimum) ceramic capacitor (10% tolerance) to
ground when using internal VREG. Higher value capacitors may be used, but
could impact supply-rail ramp-up time.
Digital I/O and Flash Power Pin – Single Supply source when VREG is enabled
Digital Ground Pins
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 2-2. Terminal Functions(1) (continued)
TERMINAL
NAME
PN
PIN #
PAG
PIN #
I/O/Z
RSH
PIN #
DESCRIPTION
VOLTAGE REGULATOR CONTROL SIGNAL
VREGENZ
73
60
53
I
Internal VREG Enable/Disable – pull low to enable VREG, pull high to disable
VREG
GPIO AND PERIPHERAL SIGNALS
GPIO0
69
56
49
I/O/Z
(1)
General-purpose input/output 0
EPWM1A
O
Enhanced PWM1 Output A and HRPWM channel
–
–
–
–
–
–
GPIO1
68
55
48
EPWM1B
I/O/Z
O
–
General-purpose input/output 1
Enhanced PWM1 Output B
–
COMP1OUT
GPIO2
O
67
54
47
EPWM2A
I/O/Z
O
Direct output of Comparator 1
General-purpose input/output 2
Enhanced PWM2 Output A and HRPWM channel
–
–
–
–
GPIO3
66
53
46
I/O/Z
General-purpose input/output 3
EPWM2B
O
Enhanced PWM2 Output B
SPISOMIA
I/O
SPI-A slave out, master in
O
Direct output of Comparator 2
COMP2OUT
GPIO4
63
51
45
EPWM3A
I/O/Z
O
–
General-purpose input/output 4
Enhanced PWM3 output A and HRPWM channel
–
–
–
GPIO5
62
50
44
I/O/Z
General-purpose input/output 5
EPWM3B
O
Enhanced PWM3 output B
SPISIMOA
I/O
SPI-A slave in, master out
ECAP1
I/O
Enhanced Capture input/output 1
GPIO6
50
39
34
I/O/Z
General-purpose input/output 6
EPWM4A
O
Enhanced PWM4 output A and HRPWM channel
EPWMSYNCI
I
External ePWM sync pulse input
EPWMSYNCO
O
External ePWM sync pulse output
GPIO7
49
38
33
I/O/Z
General-purpose input/output 7
EPWM4B
O
Enhanced PWM4 output B
SCIRXDA
I
SCI-A receive data
–
–
GPIO8
43
35
–
EPWM5A
I/O/Z
O
–
Enhanced PWM5 output A and HRPWM channel
–
ADCSOCAO
(1)
General-purpose input/output 8
O
ADC start-of-conversion A
The GPIO function (shown in bold italics) is the default at reset. The peripheral signals that are listed under them are alternate functions.
For JTAG pins that have the GPIO functionality multiplexed, the input path to the GPIO block is always valid. The output path from the
GPIO block and the path to the JTAG block from a pin is enabled/disabled based on the condition of the TRST signal. See the
TMS320x2803x Piccolo System Control and Interrupts Reference Guide (literature number SPRUGL8) for details.
Introduction
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
17
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Table 2-2. Terminal Functions(1) (continued)
TERMINAL
NAME
PN
PIN #
PAG
PIN #
RSH
PIN #
I/O/Z
39
31
–
I/O/Z
GPIO9
DESCRIPTION
General-purpose input/output 9
EPWM5B
O
Enhanced PWM5 output B
LINTXA
O
LIN transmit A
HRCAP1
I
High-resolution input capture 1
GPIO10
65
52
–
EPWM6A
I/O/Z
O
–
General-purpose input/output 10
Enhanced PWM6 output A and HRPWM channel
–
ADCSOCBO
O
GPIO11
61
49
–
I/O/Z
ADC start-of-conversion B
General-purpose input/output 11
EPWM6B
O
Enhanced PWM6 output B
LINRXA
I
LIN receive A
HRCAP2
I
High-resolution input capture 2
GPIO12
47
37
32
I/O/Z
General-purpose input/output 12
TZ1
I
Trip Zone input 1
SCITXDA
O
SCI-A transmit data
SPISIMOB
I/O
SPI-B slave in, master out.
NOTE: SPI-B is only available in the PN package.
GPIO13
76
–
–
TZ2
I/O/Z
I
–
General-purpose input/output 13
Trip Zone input 2
–
SPISOMIB
I/O
GPIO14
77
–
–
I/O/Z
SPI-B slave out, master in
General-purpose input/output 14
TZ3
I
Trip zone input 3
LINTXA
O
LIN transmit
SPICLKB
I/O
SPI-B clock input/output
GPIO15
75
–
–
I/O/Z
General-purpose input/output 15
TZ1
I
Trip zone input 1
LINRXA
I
LIN receive
SPISTEB
I/O
GPIO16
46
36
31
SPISIMOA
I/O/Z
I/O
–
General-purpose input/output 16
SPI-A slave in, master out
–
TZ2
I
GPIO17
42
SPISOMIA
34
30
I/O/Z
I/O
–
Trip Zone input 2
General-purpose input/output 17
SPI-A slave out, master in
–
TZ3
18
SPI-B slave transmit enable input/output
I
Introduction
Trip zone input 3
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 2-2. Terminal Functions(1) (continued)
TERMINAL
NAME
GPIO18
PN
PIN #
PAG
PIN #
RSH
PIN #
I/O/Z
41
33
29
I/O/Z
SPICLKA
LINTXA
XCLKOUT
GPIO19
55
44
39
DESCRIPTION
General-purpose input/output 18
I/O
SPI-A clock input/output
O
LIN transmit
O/Z
Output clock derived from SYSCLKOUT. XCLKOUT is either the same frequency,
one-half the frequency, or one-fourth the frequency of SYSCLKOUT. This is
controlled by bits 1:0 (XCLKOUTDIV) in the XCLK register. At reset, XCLKOUT =
SYSCLKOUT/4. The XCLKOUT signal can be turned off by setting XCLKOUTDIV
to 3. The mux control for GPIO18 must also be set to XCLKOUT for this signal to
propogate to the pin.
I/O/Z
General-purpose input/output 19
XCLKIN
External Oscillator Input. The path from this pin to the clock block is not gated by
the mux function of this pin. Care must be taken not to enable this path for
clocking if it is being used for the other periperhal functions
SPISTEA
I/O
SPI-A slave transmit enable input/output
LINRXA
I
ECAP1
I/O
Enhanced Capture input/output 1
I/O/Z
General-purpose input/output 20
GPIO20
78
62
55
EQEP1A
I
–
O
79
63
56
EQEP1B
I/O/Z
I
–
O
1
1
1
EQEP1S
I/O/Z
I/O
–
O
4
4
2
EQEP1I
I/O/Z
I/O
–
I
80
64
ECAP1
Direct output of Comparator 2
General-purpose input/output 22
Enhanced QEP1 strobe
LIN transmit
General-purpose input/output 23
Enhanced QEP1 index
LIN receive
–
I/O/Z
General-purpose input/output 24
See
GPIO5
and
GPIO19
I/O
Enhanced Capture input/output 1
–
–
SPISIMOB
GPIO25
Enhanced QEP1 input B
–
LINRXA
GPIO24
General-purpose input/output 21
–
LINTXA
GPIO23
Direct output of Comparator 1
–
COMP2OUT
GPIO22
Enhanced QEP1 input A
–
COMP1OUT
GPIO21
LIN receive
I/O
44
–
–
I/O/Z
–
SPI-B slave in, master out.
NOTE: SPI-B is only available in the PN and RSH packages.
General-purpose input/output 25
–
–
–
SPISOMIB
I/O
SPI-B slave out , master in
Introduction
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
19
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Table 2-2. Terminal Functions(1) (continued)
TERMINAL
NAME
PN
PIN #
PAG
PIN #
RSH
PIN #
I/O/Z
37
–
–
I/O/Z
GPIO26
HRCAP1
I
–
DESCRIPTION
General-purpose input/output 26
High-resolution input capture 1
–
SPICLKB
I/O
GPIO27
31
–
–
HRCAP2
I/O/Z
I
–
SPI-B clock input/output
General-purpose input/output 27
High-resolution input capture 2
–
SPISTEB
I/O
GPIO28
40
32
28
SCIRXDA
I/O/Z
I
SDAA
I/OD
TZ2
I
GPIO29
34
27
24
SCITXDA
I/O/Z
O
SCLA
I/OD
TZ3
I
GPIO30
33
26
23
CANRXA
I/O/Z
I
–
SPI-B slave transmit enable input/output
General-purpose input/output 28
SCI receive data
I2C data open-drain bidirectional port
Trip zone input 2
General-purpose input/output 29
SCI transmit data
I2C clock open-drain bidirectional port
Trip zone input 3
General-purpose input/output 30
CAN receive
–
–
–
GPIO31
32
25
22
CANTXA
I/O/Z
O
–
General-purpose input/output 31
CAN transmit
–
–
–
GPIO32
2
2
–
SDAA
I/O/Z
General-purpose input/output 32
I/OD
I2C data open-drain bidirectional port
EPWMSYNCI
I
Enhanced PWM external sync pulse input
ADCSOCAO
O
ADC start-of-conversion A
GPIO33
3
3
–
SCLA
I/O/Z
General-Purpose Input/Output 33
I/OD
I2C clock open-drain bidirectional port
EPWMSYNCO
O
Enhanced PWM external synch pulse output
ADCSOCBO
O
ADC start-of-conversion B
GPIO34
74
61
54
COMP2OUT
I/O/Z
O
–
Direct output of Comparator 2
–
COMP3OUT
O
GPIO35
59
47
42
TDI
I/O/Z
I
GPIO36
60
TMS
20
General-Purpose Input/Output 34
48
43
I/O/Z
I
Introduction
Direct output of Comparator 3
General-Purpose Input/Output 35
JTAG test data input (TDI) with internal pullup. TDI is clocked into the selected
register (instruction or data) on a rising edge of TCK
General-Purpose Input/Output 36
JTAG test-mode select (TMS) with internal pullup. This serial control input is
clocked into the TAP controller on the rising edge of TCK.
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 2-2. Terminal Functions(1) (continued)
TERMINAL
NAME
GPIO37
PN
PIN #
PAG
PIN #
RSH
PIN #
I/O/Z
58
46
41
I/O/Z
General-Purpose Input/Output 37
O/Z
JTAG scan out, test data output (TDO). The contents of the selected register
(instruction or data) are shifted out of TDO on the falling edge of TCK (8 mA
drive)
I/O/Z
General-Purpose Input/Output 38
TDO
GPIO38
57
45
40
DESCRIPTION
TCK
I
JTAG test clock with internal pullup
XCLKIN
I
External Oscillator Input. The path from this pin to the clock block is not gated by
the mux function of this pin. Care must be taken to not enable this path for
clocking if it is being used for the other functions.
–
GPIO39
–
56
–
–
I/O/Z
General-Purpose Input/Output 39
–
–
–
–
–
GPIO40
–
64
–
–
EPWM7A
I/O/Z
O
–
–
48
–
–
EPWM7B
I/O/Z
O
–
Enhanced PWM7 output B
–
5
–
–
I/O/Z
–
General-Purpose Input/Output 42
–
–
–
COMP1OUT
GPIO43
General-Purpose Input/Output 41
–
–
GPIO42
Enhanced PWM7 output A and HRPWM channel
–
–
GPIO41
General-Purpose Input/Output 40
O
6
–
–
I/O/Z
Direct output of Comparator 1
General-Purpose Input/Output 43
–
–
–
–
COMP2OUT
GPIO44
O
45
–
–
I/O/Z
Direct output of Comparator 2
General-Purpose Input/Output 44
–
–
–
–
–
–
Introduction
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
21
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
3 Functional Overview
3.1
Memory Maps
In Figure 3-1 through Figure 3-4, the following apply:
• Memory blocks are not to scale.
• Peripheral Frame 0, Peripheral Frame 1, Peripheral Frame 2, and Peripheral Frame 3 memory maps
are restricted to data memory only. A user program cannot access these memory maps in program
space.
• Protected means the order of Write-followed-by-Read operations is preserved rather than the pipeline
order.
• Certain memory ranges are EALLOW protected against spurious writes after configuration.
• Locations 0x3D7C80 – 0x3D7CC0 contain the internal oscillator and ADC calibration routines. These
locations are not programmable by the user.
22
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Data Space
Prog Space
0x00 0000
M0 Vector RAM (Enabled if VMAP = 0)
0x00 0040
M0 SARAM (1K x 16, 0-Wait)
0x00 0400
M1 SARAM (1K x 16, 0-Wait)
0x00 0800
Peripheral Frame 0
0x00 0D00
PIE Vector - RAM
(256 x 16)
(Enabled if
VMAP = 1,
ENPIE = 1)
Reserved
0x00 0E00
Peripheral Frame 0
0x00 1400
CLA Registers
0x00 1480
CLA-to-CPU Message RAM
0x00 1500
CPU-to-CLA Message RAM
0x00 1580
Peripheral Frame 0
0x00 2000
Reserved
0x00 6000
Peripheral Frame 1
(1K x 16, Protected)
0x00 6400
Peripheral Frame 3
(1.5K x 16, Protected)
0x00 6A00
Peripheral Frame 1
(1.5K x 16, Protected)
0x00 7000
Peripheral Frame 2
(4K x 16, Protected)
Reserved
0x00 8000
L0 SARAM (2K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, Dual-Mapped)
0x00 8800
L1 DPSARAM (1K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, CLA Data RAM 0)
0x00 8C00
L2 DPSARAM (1K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, CLA Data RAM 1)
0x00 9000
L3 DPSARAM (4K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, CLA Prog RAM)
0x00 A000
Reserved
0x3D 7800
User OTP (1K x 16, Secure Zone + ECSL)
0x3D 7C00
0x3D 7C80
0x3D 7CC0
0x3D 7CE0
0x3D 7E80
Reserved
Calibration Data
Get_mode function
Reserved
PARTID
Calibration Data
0x3D 7EB0
Reserved
0x3E 8000
0x3F 7FF8
0x3F 8000
128-Bit Password
L0 SARAM (2K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, Dual-Mapped)
0x3F 8800
Reserved
0x3F E000
Boot ROM (8K x 16, 0-Wait)
0x3F FFC0
A.
B.
FLASH
(64K x 16, 8 Sectors, Secure Zone + ECSL)
Vector (32 Vectors, Enabled if VMAP = 1)
CLA-specific registers and RAM apply to the 28035 device only.
Memory locations 0x3D7E80-0x3D7EAF are reserved in TMX silicon.
Figure 3-1. 28034/28035 Memory Map
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
23
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Data Space
Prog Space
0x00 0000
M0 Vector RAM (Enabled if VMAP = 0)
0x00 0040
M0 SARAM (1K x 16, 0-Wait)
0x00 0400
0x00 0800
0x00 0D00
0x00 0E00
M1 SARAM (1K x 16, 0-Wait)
Peripheral Frame 0
PIE Vector - RAM
(256 x 16)
(Enabled if
VMAP = 1,
ENPIE = 1)
Reserved
Peripheral Frame 0
0x00 1400
CLA Registers
0x00 1480
CLA-to-CPU Message RAM
0x00 1500
CPU-to-CLA Message RAM
0x00 1580
Peripheral Frame 0
0x00 2000
Reserved
0x00 6000
Peripheral Frame 1
(1K x 16, Protected)
0x00 6400
Peripheral Frame 3
(1.5K x 16, Protected)
0x00 6A00
Peripheral Frame 1
(1.5K x 16, Protected)
0x00 7000
Peripheral Frame 2
(4K x 16, Protected)
Reserved
0x00 8000
L0 SARAM (2K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, Dual-Mapped)
0x00 8800
L1 DPSARAM (1K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, CLA Data RAM 0)
0x00 8C00
L2 DPSARAM (1K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, CLA Data RAM 1)
0x00 9000
L3 DPSARAM (4K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, CLA Prog RAM)
0x00 A000
Reserved
0x3D 7800
User OTP (1K x 16, Secure Zone + ECSL)
0x3D 7C00
0x3D 7C80
0x3D 7CC0
0x3D 7CE0
0x3D 7E80
Reserved
Calibration Data
Get_mode function
Reserved
PARTID
Calibration Data
0x3D 7EB0
Reserved
0x3F 0000
0x3F 7FF8
0x3F 8000
A.
B.
FLASH
(32K x 16, 8 Sectors, Secure Zone + ECSL)
128-Bit Password
L0 SARAM (2K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, Dual-Mapped)
0x3F 8800
Reserved
0x3F E000
Boot ROM (8K x 16, 0-Wait)
0x3F FFC0
Vector (32 Vectors, Enabled if VMAP = 1)
CLA-specific registers and RAM apply to the 28033 device only.
Memory locations 0x3D7E80-0x3D7EAF are reserved in TMX silicon.
Figure 3-2. 28032/28033 Memory Map
24
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Data Space
Prog Space
0x00 0000
M0 Vector RAM (Enabled if VMAP = 0)
0x00 0040
M0 SARAM (1K x 16, 0-Wait)
0x00 0400
0x00 0800
0x00 0D00
0x00 0E00
M1 SARAM (1K x 16, 0-Wait)
Peripheral Frame 0
PIE Vector - RAM
(256 x 16)
(Enabled if
VMAP = 1,
ENPIE = 1)
Reserved
Peripheral Frame 0
0x00 2000
Reserved
0x00 6000
Peripheral Frame 1
(1K x 16, Protected)
0x00 6400
Peripheral Frame 3
(1.5K x 16, Protected)
0x00 6A00
Peripheral Frame 1
(1.5K x 16, Protected)
0x00 7000
Peripheral Frame 2
(4K x 16, Protected)
Reserved
0x00 8000
L0 SARAM (2K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, Dual-Mapped)
0x00 8800
L1 DPSARAM (1K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, CLA Data RAM 0)
0x00 8C00
L2 DPSARAM (1K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, CLA Data RAM 1)
0x00 9000
L3 DPSARAM (2K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, CLA Prog RAM)
0x00 9800
Reserved
0x3D 7800
User OTP (1K x 16, Secure Zone + ECSL)
0x3D 7C00
0x3D 7C80
0x3D 7CC0
0x3D 7CE0
0x3D 7E80
Reserved
Calibration Data
Get_mode function
Reserved
PARTID
Calibration Data
0x3D 7EB0
Reserved
0x3F 0000
0x3F 7FF8
0x3F 8000
128-Bit Password
L0 SARAM (2K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, Dual-Mapped)
0x3F 8800
Reserved
0x3F E000
Boot ROM (8K x 16, 0-Wait)
0x3F FFC0
A.
FLASH
(32K x 16, 8 Sectors, Secure Zone + ECSL)
Vector (32 Vectors, Enabled if VMAP = 1)
Memory locations 0x3D7E80-0x3D7EAF are reserved in TMX silicon.
Figure 3-3. 28031 Memory Map
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
25
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Data Space
Prog Space
0x00 0000
M0 Vector RAM (Enabled if VMAP = 0)
0x00 0040
M0 SARAM (1K x 16, 0-Wait)
0x00 0400
0x00 0800
0x00 0D00
0x00 0E00
M1 SARAM (1K x 16, 0-Wait)
Peripheral Frame 0
PIE Vector - RAM
(256 x 16)
(Enabled if
VMAP = 1,
ENPIE = 1)
Reserved
Peripheral Frame 0
0x00 2000
Reserved
0x00 6000
Peripheral Frame 1
(1K x 16, Protected)
0x00 6400
Peripheral Frame 3
(1.5K x 16, Protected)
0x00 6A00
Peripheral Frame 1
(1.5K x 16, Protected)
0x00 7000
Peripheral Frame 2
(4K x 16, Protected)
Reserved
0x00 8000
L0 SARAM (2K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, Dual-Mapped)
0x00 8800
L1 DPSARAM (1K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, CLA Data RAM 0)
0x00 8C00
L2 DPSARAM (1K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, CLA Data RAM 1)
0x00 9000
Reserved
0x00 A000
Reserved
0x3D 7800
User OTP (1K x 16, Secure Zone + ECSL)
0x3D 7C00
0x3D 7C80
0x3D 7CC0
0x3D 7CE0
0x3D 7E80
Reserved
Calibration Data
Get_mode function
Reserved
PARTID
Calibration Data
0x3D 7EB0
Reserved
0x3F 4000
0x3F 7FF8
0x3F 8000
128-Bit Password
L0 SARAM (2K x 16)
(0-Wait, Secure Zone + ECSL, Dual-Mapped)
0x3F 8800
Reserved
0x3F E000
Boot ROM (8K x 16, 0-Wait)
0x3F FFC0
A.
FLASH
(16K x 16, 4 Sectors, Secure Zone + ECSL)
Vector (32 Vectors, Enabled if VMAP = 1)
Memory locations 0x3D7E80-0x3D7EAF are reserved in TMX silicon.
Figure 3-4. 28030 Memory Map
26
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 3-1. Addresses of Flash Sectors in F28034/28035
ADDRESS RANGE
PROGRAM AND DATA SPACE
0x3E 8000 – 0x3E 9FFF
Sector H (8K x 16)
0x3E A000 – 0x3E BFFF
Sector G (8K x 16)
0x3E C000 – 0x3E DFFF
Sector F (8K x 16)
0x3E E000 – 0x3E FFFF
Sector E (8K x 16)
0x3F 0000 – 0x3F 1FFF
Sector D (8K x 16)
0x3F 2000 – 0x3F 3FFF
Sector C (8K x 16)
0x3F 4000 – 0x3F 5FFF
Sector B (8K x 16)
0x3F 6000 – 0x3F 7F7F
Sector A (8K x 16)
0x3F 7F80 – 0x3F 7FF5
Program to 0x0000 when using the
Code Security Module
0x3F 7FF6 – 0x3F 7FF7
Boot-to-Flash Entry Point
(program branch instruction here)
0x3F 7FF8 – 0x3F 7FFF
Security Password (128-Bit)
(Do not program to all zeros)
Table 3-2. Addresses of Flash Sectors in F28031/28032/28033
ADDRESS RANGE
PROGRAM AND DATA SPACE
0x3F 0000 – 0x3F 0FFF
Sector H (4K x 16)
0x3F 1000 – 0x3F 1FFF
Sector G (4K x 16)
0x3F 2000 – 0x3F 2FFF
Sector F (4K x 16)
0x3F 3000 – 0x3F 3FFF
Sector E (4K x 16)
0x3F 4000 – 0x3F 4FFF
Sector D (4K x 16)
0x3F 5000 – 0x3F 5FFF
Sector C (4K x 16)
0x3F 6000 – 0x3F 6FFF
Sector B (4K x 16)
0x3F 7000 – 0x3F 7F7F
Sector A (4K x 16)
0x3F 7F80 – 0x3F 7FF5
Program to 0x0000 when using the
Code Security Module
0x3F 7FF6 – 0x3F 7FF7
Boot-to-Flash Entry Point
(program branch instruction here)
0x3F 7FF8 – 0x3F 7FFF
Security Password (128-Bit)
(Do not program to all zeros)
Table 3-3. Addresses of Flash Sectors in F28030
ADDRESS RANGE
PROGRAM AND DATA SPACE
0x3F 4000 – 0x3F 4FFF
Sector D (4K x 16)
0x3F 5000 – 0x3F 5FFF
Sector C (4K x 16)
0x3F 6000 – 0x3F 6FFF
Sector B (4K x 16)
0x3F 7000 – 0x3F 7F7F
Sector A (4K x 16)
0x3F 7F80 – 0x3F 7FF5
Program to 0x0000 when using the
Code Security Module
0x3F 7FF6 – 0x3F 7FF7
Boot-to-Flash Entry Point
(program branch instruction here)
0x3F 7FF8 – 0x3F 7FFF
Security Password (128-Bit)
(Do not program to all zeros)
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
27
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
NOTE
•
When the code-security passwords are programmed, all addresses between 0x3F 7F80
and 0x3F 7FF5 cannot be used as program code or data. These locations must be
programmed to 0x0000.
• If the code security feature is not used, addresses 0x3F 7F80 through 0x3F 7FEF may
be used for code or data. Addresses 0x3F 7FF0 – 0x3F 7FF5 are reserved for data and
should not contain program code.
Table 3-4 shows how to handle these memory locations.
Table 3-4. Impact of Using the Code Security Module
FLASH
ADDRESS
CODE SECURITY ENABLED
0x3F 7F80 – 0x3F 7FEF
CODE SECURITY DISABLED
Application code and data
Fill with 0x0000
0x3F 7FF0 – 0x3F 7FF5
Reserved for data only
Peripheral Frame 1, Peripheral Frame 2, and Peripheral Frame 3 are grouped together to enable these
blocks to be write/read peripheral block protected. The protected mode makes sure that all accesses to
these blocks happen as written. Because of the pipeline, a write immediately followed by a read to
different memory locations, will appear in reverse order on the memory bus of the CPU. This can cause
problems in certain peripheral applications where the user expected the write to occur first (as written).
The CPU supports a block protection mode where a region of memory can be protected so that operations
occur as written (the penalty is extra cycles are added to align the operations). This mode is
programmable and by default, it protects the selected zones.
The wait-states for the various spaces in the memory map area are listed in Table 3-5.
Table 3-5. Wait-States
AREA
WAIT-STATES (CPU)
M0 and M1 SARAMs
0-wait
Peripheral Frame 0
0-wait
Peripheral Frame 1
0-wait (writes)
Cycles can be extended by peripheral generated ready.
2-wait (reads)
Back-to-back write operations to Peripheral Frame 1 registers will incur
a 1-cycle stall (1-cycle delay).
0-wait (writes)
Fixed. Cycles cannot be extended by the peripheral.
Peripheral Frame 2
COMMENTS
Fixed
2-wait (reads)
Peripheral Frame 3
0-wait (writes)
Assumes no conflict between CPU and CLA.
2-wait (reads)
Cycles can be extended by peripheral-generated ready.
L0 SARAM
0-wait data and program
Assumes no CPU conflicts
L1 SARAM
0-wait data and program
Assumes no CPU conflicts
L2 SARAM
0-wait data and program
Assumes no CPU conflicts
L3 SARAM
0-wait data and program
Assumes no CPU conflicts
OTP
FLASH
Programmable
Programmed via the Flash registers.
1-wait minimum
1-wait is minimum number of wait states allowed.
Programmable
Programmed via the Flash registers.
0-wait Paged min
1-wait Random min
Random ≥ Paged
28
FLASH Password
16-wait fixed
Boot-ROM
0-wait
Functional Overview
Wait states of password locations are fixed.
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
3.2
3.2.1
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Brief Descriptions
CPU
The 2803x (C28x) family is a member of the TMS320C2000™ microcontroller (MCU) platform. The C28xbased controllers have the same 32-bit fixed-point architecture as existing C28x MCUs. It is a very
efficient C/C++ engine, enabling users to develop not only their system control software in a high-level
language, but also enabling development of math algorithms using C/C++. The device is as efficient at
MCU math tasks as it is at system control tasks that typically are handled by microcontroller devices. This
efficiency removes the need for a second processor in many systems. The 32 x 32-bit MAC 64-bit
processing capabilities enable the controller to handle higher numerical resolution problems efficiently.
Add to this the fast interrupt response with automatic context save of critical registers, resulting in a device
that is capable of servicing many asynchronous events with minimal latency. The device has an 8-leveldeep protected pipeline with pipelined memory accesses. This pipelining enables it to execute at high
speeds without resorting to expensive high-speed memories. Special branch-look-ahead hardware
minimizes the latency for conditional discontinuities. Special store conditional operations further improve
performance.
3.2.2
Control Law Accelerator (CLA)
The C28x control law accelerator is a single-precision (32-bit) floating-point unit that extends the
capabilities of the C28x CPU by adding parallel processing. The CLA is an independent processor with its
own bus structure, fetch mechanism, and pipeline. Eight individual CLA tasks, or routines, can be
specified. Each task is started by software or a peripheral such as the ADC, an ePWM, or CPU Timer 0.
The CLA executes one task at a time to completion. When a task completes the main CPU is notified by
an interrupt to the PIE and the CLA automatically begins the next highest-priority pending task. The CLA
can directly access the ADC Result registers and the ePWM+HRPWM registers. Dedicated message
RAMs provide a method to pass additional data between the main CPU and the CLA.
3.2.3
Memory Bus (Harvard Bus Architecture)
As with many MCU-type devices, multiple busses are used to move data between the memories and
peripherals and the CPU. The memory bus architecture contains a program read bus, data read bus, and
data write bus. The program read bus consists of 22 address lines and 32 data lines. The data read and
write busses consist of 32 address lines and 32 data lines each. The 32-bit-wide data busses enable
single cycle 32-bit operations. The multiple bus architecture, commonly termed Harvard Bus, enables the
C28x to fetch an instruction, read a data value and write a data value in a single cycle. All peripherals and
memories attached to the memory bus prioritize memory accesses. Generally, the priority of memory bus
accesses can be summarized as follows:
Highest:
Data Writes
(Simultaneous data and program writes cannot occur on the
memory bus.)
Program Writes
(Simultaneous data and program writes cannot occur on the
memory bus.)
Data Reads
Lowest:
Program Reads
(Simultaneous program reads and fetches cannot occur on the
memory bus.)
Fetches
(Simultaneous program reads and fetches cannot occur on the
memory bus.)
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
29
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
3.2.4
www.ti.com
Peripheral Bus
To enable migration of peripherals between various Texas Instruments (TI) MCU family of devices, the
devices adopt a peripheral bus standard for peripheral interconnect. The peripheral bus bridge multiplexes
the various busses that make up the processor Memory Bus into a single bus consisting of 16 address
lines and 16 or 32 data lines and associated control signals. Three versions of the peripheral bus are
supported. One version supports only 16-bit accesses (called peripheral frame 2). Another version
supports both 16- and 32-bit accesses (called peripheral frame 1). The third version supports CLA access
and both 16- and 32-bit accesses (called peripheral frame 3).
3.2.5
Real-Time JTAG and Analysis
The devices implement the standard IEEE 1149.1 JTAG (1) interface for in-circuit based debug.
Additionally, the devices support real-time mode of operation allowing modification of the contents of
memory, peripheral, and register locations while the processor is running and executing code and
servicing interrupts. The user can also single step through non-time-critical code while enabling timecritical interrupts to be serviced without interference. The device implements the real-time mode in
hardware within the CPU. This is a feature unique to the 28x family of devices, requiring no software
monitor. Additionally, special analysis hardware is provided that allows setting of hardware breakpoint or
data/address watch-points and generating various user-selectable break events when a match occurs.
3.2.6
Flash
The F28035/34 devices contain 64K x 16 of embedded flash memory, segregated into eight 8K x 16
sectors. The F28033/32/31 devices contain 32K x 16 of embedded flash memory, segregated into eight
4K x 16 sectors. The F28030 device contains 16K x 16 of embedded flash memory, segregated into four
4K x 16 sectors. All devices also contain a single 1K x 16 of OTP memory at address range 0x3D 7800 –
0x3D 7BFF. The user can individually erase, program, and validate a flash sector while leaving other
sectors untouched. However, it is not possible to use one sector of the flash or the OTP to execute flash
algorithms that erase/program other sectors. Special memory pipelining is provided to enable the flash
module to achieve higher performance. The flash/OTP is mapped to both program and data space;
therefore, it can be used to execute code or store data information. Addresses 0x3F 7FF0 – 0x3F 7FF5
are reserved for data variables and should not contain program code.
NOTE
The Flash and OTP wait-states can be configured by the application. This allows applications
running at slower frequencies to configure the flash to use fewer wait-states.
Flash effective performance can be improved by enabling the flash pipeline mode in the
Flash options register. With this mode enabled, effective performance of linear code
execution will be much faster than the raw performance indicated by the wait-state
configuration alone. The exact performance gain when using the Flash pipeline mode is
application-dependent.
For more information on the Flash options, Flash wait-state, and OTP wait-state registers,
see the TMS320x2803x Piccolo System Control and Interrupts Reference Guide (literature
number SPRUGL8).
3.2.7
M0, M1 SARAMs
All devices contain these two blocks of single access memory, each 1K x 16 in size. The stack pointer
points to the beginning of block M1 on reset. The M0 and M1 blocks, like all other memory blocks on C28x
devices, are mapped to both program and data space. Hence, the user can use M0 and M1 to execute
code or for data variables. The partitioning is performed within the linker. The C28x device presents a
unified memory map to the programmer. This makes for easier programming in high-level languages.
(1)
30
IEEE Standard 1149.1-1990 Standard Test Access Port and Boundary Scan Architecture
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
3.2.8
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
L0 SARAM, and L1, L2, and L3 DPSARAMs
The device contains up to 8K x 16 of single-access RAM. To ascertain the exact size for a given device,
see the device-specific memory map figures in Section 3.1. This block is mapped to both program and
data space. Block L0 is 2K in size and is dual mapped to both program and data space. Blocks L1 and L2
are both 1K in size and are shared with the CLA which can ultilize these blocks for its data space. Block
L3 is 4K (2K on the 28031 device) in size and is shared with the CLA which can ultilize this block for its
program space. DPSARAM refers to the dual-port configuration of these blocks.
3.2.9
Boot ROM
The Boot ROM is factory-programmed with boot-loading software. Boot-mode signals are provided to tell
the bootloader software what boot mode to use on power up. The user can select to boot normally or to
download new software from an external connection or to select boot software that is programmed in the
internal Flash/ROM. The Boot ROM also contains standard tables, such as SIN/COS waveforms, for use
in math-related algorithms.
Table 3-6. Boot Mode Selection
MODE
GPIO37/TDO
GPIO34/COMP2OUT/
COMP3OUT
TRST
3
1
1
0
GetMode
2
1
0
0
Wait (see Section 3.2.10 for description)
1
0
1
0
SCI
0
0
0
0
Parallel IO
EMU
x
x
1
Emulation Boot
3.2.9.1
MODE
Emulation Boot
When the emulator is connected, the GPIO37/TDO pin cannot be used for boot mode selection. In this
case, the boot ROM detects that an emulator is connected and uses the contents of two reserved SARAM
locations in the PIE vector table to determine the boot mode. If the content of either location is invalid,
then the Wait boot option is used. All boot mode options can be accessed in emulation boot.
3.2.9.2
GetMode
The default behavior of the GetMode option is to boot to flash. This behavior can be changed to another
boot option by programming two locations in the OTP. If the content of either OTP location is invalid, then
boot to flash is used. One of the following loaders can be specified: SCI, SPI, I2C, CAN, or OTP.
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
31
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
3.2.9.3
www.ti.com
Peripheral Pins Used by the Bootloader
Table 3-7 shows which GPIO pins are used by each peripheral bootloader. Refer to the GPIO mux table
to see if these conflict with any of the peripherals you would like to use in your application.
Table 3-7. Peripheral Bootload Pins
BOOTLOADER
PERIPHERAL LOADER PINS
SCI
SCIRXDA (GPIO28)
SCITXDA (GPIO29)
Parallel Boot
Data (GPIO31,30,5:0)
28x Control (AIO6)
Host Control (AIO12)
SPI
SPISIMOA (GPIO16)
SPISOMIA (GPIO17)
SPICLKA (GPIO18)
SPISTEA (GPIO19)
I2C
SDAA (GPIO32)
SCLA (GPIO33)
CAN
CANRXA (GPIO30)
CANTXA (GPIO31)
3.2.10 Security
The devices support high levels of security to protect the user firmware from being reverse engineered.
The security features a 128-bit password (hardcoded for 16 wait-states), which the user programs into the
flash. One code security module (CSM) is used to protect the flash/OTP and the L0/L1 SARAM blocks.
The security feature prevents unauthorized users from examining the memory contents via the JTAG port,
executing code from external memory or trying to boot-load some undesirable software that would export
the secure memory contents. To enable access to the secure blocks, the user must write the correct 128bit KEY value that matches the value stored in the password locations within the Flash.
In addition to the CSM, the emulation code security logic (ECSL) has been implemented to prevent
unauthorized users from stepping through secure code. Any code or data access to CSM secure memory
while the emulator is connected will trip the ECSL and break the emulation connection. To allow emulation
of secure code, while maintaining the CSM protection against secure memory reads, the user must write
the correct value into the lower 64 bits of the KEY register, which matches the value stored in the lower 64
bits of the password locations within the flash. Note that dummy reads of all 128 bits of the password in
the flash must still be performed. If the lower 64 bits of the password locations are all ones
(unprogrammed), then the KEY value does not need to match.
When initially debugging a device with the password locations in flash programmed (that is, secured), the
CPU will start running and may execute an instruction that performs an access to a protected ECSL area.
If this happens, the ECSL will trip and cause the emulator connection to be cut.
32
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
The solution is to use the Wait boot option. This will sit in a loop around a software breakpoint to allow an
emulator to be connected without tripping security. Piccolo devices do not support a hardware wait-inreset mode.
NOTE
•
When the code-security passwords are programmed, all addresses between 0x3F7F80
and 0x3F7FF5 cannot be used as program code or data. These locations must be
programmed to 0x0000.
• If the code security feature is not used, addresses 0x3F7F80 through 0x3F7FEF may be
used for code or data. Addresses 0x3F7FF0 – 0x3F7FF5 are reserved for data and
should not contain program code.
The 128-bit password (at 0x3F 7FF8 – 0x3F 7FFF) must not be programmed to zeros. Doing
so would permanently lock the device.
Disclaimer
Code Security Module Disclaimer
THE CODE SECURITY MODULE (CSM) INCLUDED ON THIS DEVICE WAS DESIGNED
TO PASSWORD PROTECT THE DATA STORED IN THE ASSOCIATED MEMORY
(EITHER ROM OR FLASH) AND IS WARRANTED BY TEXAS INSTRUMENTS (TI), IN
ACCORDANCE WITH ITS STANDARD TERMS AND CONDITIONS, TO CONFORM TO
TI'S PUBLISHED SPECIFICATIONS FOR THE WARRANTY PERIOD APPLICABLE FOR
THIS DEVICE.
TI DOES NOT, HOWEVER, WARRANT OR REPRESENT THAT THE CSM CANNOT BE
COMPROMISED OR BREACHED OR THAT THE DATA STORED IN THE ASSOCIATED
MEMORY CANNOT BE ACCESSED THROUGH OTHER MEANS. MOREOVER, EXCEPT
AS SET FORTH ABOVE, TI MAKES NO WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS
CONCERNING THE CSM OR OPERATION OF THIS DEVICE, INCLUDING ANY IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
IN NO EVENT SHALL TI BE LIABLE FOR ANY CONSEQUENTIAL, SPECIAL, INDIRECT,
INCIDENTAL, OR PUNITIVE DAMAGES, HOWEVER CAUSED, ARISING IN ANY WAY
OUT OF YOUR USE OF THE CSM OR THIS DEVICE, WHETHER OR NOT TI HAS BEEN
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. EXCLUDED DAMAGES INCLUDE,
BUT ARE NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA, LOSS OF GOODWILL, LOSS OF USE OR
INTERRUPTION OF BUSINESS OR OTHER ECONOMIC LOSS.
3.2.11 Peripheral Interrupt Expansion (PIE) Block
The PIE block serves to multiplex numerous interrupt sources into a smaller set of interrupt inputs. The
PIE block can support up to 96 peripheral interrupts. On the F2803x, 56 of the possible 96 interrupts are
used by peripherals. The 96 interrupts are grouped into blocks of 8 and each group is fed into 1 of
12 CPU interrupt lines (INT1 to INT12). Each of the 96 interrupts is supported by its own vector stored in a
dedicated RAM block that can be overwritten by the user. The vector is automatically fetched by the CPU
on servicing the interrupt. It takes 8 CPU clock cycles to fetch the vector and save critical CPU registers.
Hence the CPU can quickly respond to interrupt events. Prioritization of interrupts is controlled in
hardware and software. Each individual interrupt can be enabled/disabled within the PIE block.
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
33
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
3.2.12 External Interrupts (XINT1–XINT3)
The devices support three masked external interrupts (XINT1–XINT3). Each of the interrupts can be
selected for negative, positive, or both negative and positive edge triggering and can also be
enabled/disabled. These interrupts also contain a 16-bit free running up counter, which is reset to zero
when a valid interrupt edge is detected. This counter can be used to accurately time stamp the interrupt.
There are no dedicated pins for the external interrupts. XINT1, XINT2, and XINT3 interrupts can accept
inputs from GPIO0–GPIO31 pins.
3.2.13 Internal Zero Pin Oscillators, Oscillator, and PLL
The device can be clocked by either of the two internal zero-pin oscillators, an external oscillator, or by a
crystal attached to the on-chip oscillator circuit. A PLL is provided supporting up to 12 input-clock-scaling
ratios. The PLL ratios can be changed on-the-fly in software, enabling the user to scale back on operating
frequency if lower power operation is desired. Refer to Section 6, Electrical Specifications, for timing
details. The PLL block can be set in bypass mode.
3.2.14 Watchdog
Each device contains two watchdogs: CPU-Watchdog that monitors the core and NMI-Watchdog that is a
missing clock-detect circuit. The user software must regularly reset the CPU-watchdog counter within a
certain time frame; otherwise, the CPU-watchdog generates a reset to the processor. The CPU-watchdog
can be disabled if necessary. The NMI-Watchdog engages only in case of a clock failure and can either
generate an interrupt or a device reset.
3.2.15 Peripheral Clocking
The clocks to each individual peripheral can be enabled/disabled to reduce power consumption when a
peripheral is not in use. Additionally, the system clock to the serial ports (except I2C) can be scaled
relative to the CPU clock.
3.2.16 Low-power Modes
The devices are full static CMOS devices. Three low-power modes are provided:
IDLE:
Place CPU in low-power mode. Peripheral clocks may be turned off selectively and
only those peripherals that need to function during IDLE are left operating. An
enabled interrupt from an active peripheral or the watchdog timer will wake the
processor from IDLE mode.
STANDBY: Turns off clock to CPU and peripherals. This mode leaves the oscillator and PLL
functional. An external interrupt event will wake the processor and the peripherals.
Execution begins on the next valid cycle after detection of the interrupt event
HALT:
This mode basically shuts down the device and places it in the lowest possible power
consumption mode. If the internal zero-pin oscillators are used as the clock source,
the HALT mode turns them off, by default. To keep these oscillators from shutting
down, the INTOSCnHALTI bits in CLKCTL register may be used. The zero-pin
oscillators may thus be used to clock the CPU-watchdog in this mode. If the on-chip
crystal oscillator is used as the clock source, it is shut down in this mode. A reset or
an external signal (through a GPIO pin) or the CPU-watchdog can wake the device
from this mode.
The CPU clock (OSCCLK) and WDCLK should be from the same clock source before attempting to put
the device into HALT or STANDBY.
34
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
3.2.17 Peripheral Frames 0, 1, 2, 3 (PFn)
The device segregates peripherals into four sections. The mapping of peripherals is as follows:
PF0:
PF1:
PF2:
PIE:
PIE Interrupt Enable and Control Registers Plus PIE Vector Table
Flash:
Flash Waitstate Registers
Timers:
CPU-Timers 0, 1, 2 Registers
CSM:
Code Security Module KEY Registers
ADC:
ADC Result Registers
CLA
Control Law Accelrator Registers and Message RAMs
GPIO:
GPIO MUX Configuration and Control Registers
eCAN:
Enhanced Control Area Network Configuration and Control Registers
LIN:
Local Interconnect Network Configuration and Control Registers
eCAP:
Enhanced Capture Module and Registers
eQEP:
Enhanced Quadrature Encoder Pulse Module and Registers
HRCAP:
High-Resolution Capture Module and Registers
SYS:
System Control Registers
SCI:
Serial Communications Interface (SCI) Control and RX/TX Registers
SPI:
Serial Port Interface (SPI) Control and RX/TX Registers
ADC:
ADC Status, Control, and Configuration Registers
2
PF3:
I C:
Inter-Integrated Circuit Module and Registers
XINT:
External Interrupt Registers
ePWM:
Enhanced Pulse Width Modulator Module and Registers
HRPWM:
High-Resolution Pulse-Width Modulator Registers
Comparators:
Comparator Modules
3.2.18 General-Purpose Input/Output (GPIO) Multiplexer
Most of the peripheral signals are multiplexed with general-purpose input/output (GPIO) signals. This
enables the user to use a pin as GPIO if the peripheral signal or function is not used. On reset, GPIO pins
are configured as inputs. The user can individually program each pin for GPIO mode or peripheral signal
mode. For specific inputs, the user can also select the number of input qualification cycles. This is to filter
unwanted noise glitches. The GPIO signals can also be used to bring the device out of specific low-power
modes.
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
35
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
3.2.19 32-Bit CPU-Timers (0, 1, 2)
CPU-Timers 0, 1, and 2 are identical 32-bit timers with presettable periods and with 16-bit clock
prescaling. The timers have a 32-bit count-down register, which generates an interrupt when the counter
reaches zero. The counter is decremented at the CPU clock speed divided by the prescale value setting.
When the counter reaches zero, it is automatically reloaded with a 32-bit period value.
CPU-Timer 0 is for general use and is connected to the PIE block. CPU-Timer 1 is also for general use
and can be connected to INT13 of the CPU. CPU-Timer 2 is reserved for DSP/BIOS. It is connected to
INT14 of the CPU. If DSP/BIOS is not being used, CPU-Timer 2 is available for general use.
CPU-Timer 2 can be clocked by any one of the following:
• SYSCLKOUT (default)
• Internal zero-pin oscillator 1 (INTOSC1)
• Internal zero-pin oscillator 2 (INTOSC2)
• External clock source
3.2.20 Control Peripherals
The devices support the following peripherals that are used for embedded control and communication:
36
ePWM:
The enhanced PWM peripheral supports independent/complementary PWM
generation, adjustable dead-band generation for leading/trailing edges,
latched/cycle-by-cycle trip mechanism. Some of the PWM pins support the
HRPWM high resolution duty and period features. The type 1 module found on
2803x devices also supports increased dead-band resolution, enhanced SOC and
interrupt generation, and advanced triggering including trip functions based on
comparator outputs.
eCAP:
The enhanced capture peripheral uses a 32-bit time base and registers up to four
programmable events in continuous/one-shot capture modes.
This peripheral can also be configured to generate an auxiliary PWM signal.
eQEP:
The enhanced QEP peripheral uses a 32-bit position counter, supports low-speed
measurement using capture unit and high-speed measurement using a 32-bit unit
timer. This peripheral has a watchdog timer to detect motor stall and input error
detection logic to identify simultaneous edge transition in QEP signals.
ADC:
The ADC block is a 12-bit converter. It has up to 16 single-ended channels pinned
out, depending on the device. It contains two sample-and-hold units for
simultaneous sampling.
Comparator:
Each comparator block consists of one analog comparator along with an internal
10-bit reference for supplying one input of the comparator.
HRCAP:
The high-resolution capture peripheral operates in normal capture mode via a 16bit counter clocked off of the HCCAPCLK or in high-resolution capture mode by
utilizing built-in calibration logic in conjunction with a TI-supplied calibration library.
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
3.2.21 Serial Port Peripherals
The devices support the following serial communication peripherals:
SPI:
The SPI is a high-speed, synchronous serial I/O port that allows a serial bit stream
of programmed length (one to sixteen bits) to be shifted into and out of the device
at a programmable bit-transfer rate. Normally, the SPI is used for communications
between the MCU and external peripherals or another processor. Typical
applications include external I/O or peripheral expansion through devices such as
shift registers, display drivers, and ADCs. Multi-device communications are
supported by the master/slave operation of the SPI. The SPI contains a 4-level
receive and transmit FIFO for reducing interrupt servicing overhead.
SCI:
The serial communications interface is a two-wire asynchronous serial port,
commonly known as UART. The SCI contains a 4-level receive and transmit FIFO
for reducing interrupt servicing overhead.
I2C:
The inter-integrated circuit (I2C) module provides an interface between a MCU and
other devices compliant with Philips Semiconductors Inter-IC bus ( I2C-bus®)
specification version 2.1 and connected by way of an I2C-bus. External
components attached to this 2-wire serial bus can transmit/receive up to 8-bit data
to/from the MCU through the I2C module. The I2C contains a 4-level receive and
transmit FIFO for reducing interrupt servicing overhead.
eCAN:
This is the enhanced version of the CAN peripheral. It supports 32 mailboxes, time
stamping of messages, and is CAN 2.0B-compliant.
LIN:
LIN 1.3 or 2.0 compatible peripheral. Can also be configured as additional SCI
port
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
37
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
3.3
www.ti.com
Register Map
The devices contain four peripheral register spaces. The spaces are categorized as follows:
Peripheral Frame 0: These are peripherals that are mapped directly to the CPU memory bus.
See Table 3-8.
Peripheral Frame 1: These are peripherals that are mapped to the 32-bit peripheral bus. See
Table 3-9.
Peripheral Frame 2: These are peripherals that are mapped to the 16-bit peripheral bus. See
Table 3-10.
Peripheral Frame 3: These are peripherals that are mapped to the 32-bit peripheral bus and are
accessible by the CLA. See Table 3-11.
Table 3-8. Peripheral Frame 0 Registers (1)
NAME
Device Emulation Registers
ADDRESS RANGE
SIZE (×16)
EALLOW PROTECTED (2)
0x00 0880 – 0x00 0984
261
Yes
System Power Control Registers
0x00 0985 – 0x00 0987
3
Yes
FLASH Registers (3)
0x00 0A80 – 0x00 0ADF
96
Yes
Code Security Module Registers
0x00 0AE0 – 0x00 0AEF
16
Yes
ADC registers
(0 wait read only)
0x00 0B00 – 0x00 0B0F
16
No
CPU–TIMER0/1/2 Registers
0x00 0C00 – 0x00 0C3F
64
No
PIE Registers
0x00 0CE0 – 0x00 0CFF
32
No
PIE Vector Table
0x00 0D00 – 0x00 0DFF
256
No
CLA Registers
0x00 1400 – 0x00 147F
128
Yes
CLA to CPU Message RAM (CPU writes ignored)
0x00 1480 – 0x00 14FF
128
NA
CPU to CLA Message RAM (CLA writes ignored)
0x00 1500 – 0x00 157F
128
NA
(1)
(2)
(3)
Registers in Frame 0 support 16-bit and 32-bit accesses.
If registers are EALLOW protected, then writes cannot be performed until the EALLOW instruction is executed. The EDIS instruction
disables writes to prevent stray code or pointers from corrupting register contents.
The Flash Registers are also protected by the Code Security Module (CSM).
Table 3-9. Peripheral Frame 1 Registers
NAME
ADDRESS RANGE
SIZE (×16)
0x00 6000 – 0x00 61FF
512
eCAP1 registers
0x00 6A00 – 0x00 6A1F
32
No
HRCAP1 registers
0x00 6AC0 – 0x00 6ADF
32
(1)
HRCAP2 registers
0x00 6AE0 – 0x00 6AFF
32
(1)
eQEP1 registers
0x00 6B00 – 0x00 6B3F
64
(1)
LIN-A registers
0x00 6C00 – 0x00 6C7F
128
(1)
GPIO registers
0x00 6F80 – 0x00 6FFF
128
(1)
eCAN-A registers
(1)
38
EALLOW PROTECTED
(1)
Some registers are EALLOW protected. See the module reference guide for more information.
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 3-10. Peripheral Frame 2 Registers
ADDRESS RANGE
SIZE (×16)
EALLOW PROTECTED
System Control Registers
NAME
0x00 7010 – 0x00 702F
32
Yes
SPI-A Registers
0x00 7040 – 0x00 704F
16
No
SCI-A Registers
0x00 7050 – 0x00 705F
16
No
NMI Watchdog Interrupt Registers
0x00 7060 – 0x00 706F
16
Yes
External Interrupt Registers
0x00 7070 – 0x00 707F
16
Yes
ADC Registers
0x00 7100 – 0x00 717F
128
(1)
I2C-A Registers
0x00 7900 – 0x00 793F
64
(1)
SPI-B Registers
0x00 7740 – 0x00 774F
16
No
EALLOW PROTECTED
(1)
Some registers are EALLOW protected. See the module reference guide for more information.
Table 3-11. Peripheral Frame 3 Registers
ADDRESS RANGE
SIZE (×16)
Comparator 1 registers
NAME
0x00 6400 – 0x00 641F
32
(1)
Comparator 2 registers
0x00 6420 – 0x00 643F
32
(1)
Comparator 3 registers
0x00 6440 – 0x00 645F
32
(1)
ePWM1 + HRPWM1 registers
0x00 6800 – 0x00 683F
64
(1)
ePWM2 + HRPWM2 registers
0x00 6840 – 0x00 687F
64
(1)
ePWM3 + HRPWM3 registers
0x00 6880 – 0x00 68BF
64
(1)
ePWM4 + HRPWM4 registers
0x00 68C0 – 0x00 68FF
64
(1)
ePWM5 + HRPWM5 registers
0x00 6900 – 0x00 693F
64
(1)
ePWM6 + HRPWM6 registers
0x00 6940 – 0x00 697F
64
(1)
ePWM7 + HRPWM7 registers
0x00 6980 – 0x00 69BF
64
(1)
(1)
Some registers are EALLOW protected. See the module reference guide for more information.
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
39
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
3.4
www.ti.com
Device Emulation Registers
These registers are used to control the protection mode of the C28x CPU and to monitor some critical
device signals. The registers are defined in Table 3-12 .
Table 3-12. Device Emulation Registers
NAME
DEVICECNF
PARTID (1)
CLASSID
REVID
ADDRESS
RANGE
SIZE (x16)
0x0880
0x0881
2
Device Configuration Register
0x3D 7E80
1
Part ID Register
0x0882
0x0883
1
1
EALLOW
PROTECTED
DESCRIPTION
Class ID Register
Revision ID
Register
Yes
TMS320F28035PN
0x00BF
TMS320F28035PAG
0x00BE
TMS320F28035RSH
0x00BD
TMS320F28034PN
0x00BB
TMS320F28034PAG
0x00BA
TMS320F28034RSH
0x00B9
TMS320F28033PN
0x00B7
TMS320F28033PAG
0x00B6
TMS320F28033RSH
0x00B5
TMS320F28032PN
0x00B3
TMS320F28032PAG
0x00B2
TMS320F28032RSH
0x00B1
TMS320F28031PN
0x00AF
TMS320F28031PAG
0x00AE
TMS320F28031RSH
0x00AD
TMS320F28030PN
0x00AB
TMS320F28030PAG
0x00AA
TMS320F28030RSH
0x00A9
TMS320F28035
0x00BF
TMS320F28034
0x00BB
TMS320F28033
0x00B7
TMS320F28032
0x00B3
TMS320F28031
0x00AF
TMS320F28030
0x00AB
0x0000 - Silicon Rev. 0 - TMS
No
No
No
0x0001 - Silicon Rev. A - TMS
(1)
40
For TMS320F2803x devices, the PARTID register location differs from the TMS320F2802x devices' location of 0x3D7FFF.
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
3.5
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Interrupts
Figure 3-5 shows how the various interrupt sources are multiplexed.
Peripherals
2
(SPI, SCI, ePWM, I C, HRPWM, HRCAP,
eCAP, ADC, eQEP, CLA, LIN, eCAN)
WDINT
WAKEINT
Sync
Watchdog
LPMINT
Low Power Modes
XINT1
Interrupt Control
MUX
SYSCLKOUT
XINT1
C28
Core
GPIOXINT1SEL(4:0)
ADC
XINT2
XINT2SOC
XINT2
Interrupt Control
MUX
PIE
INT1
to
INT12
Up to 96 Interrupts
XINT1CR(15:0)
XINT2CTR(15:0)
XINT2CR(15:0)
XINT3CTR(15:0)
GPIOXINT2SEL(4:0)
XINT3
Interrupt Control
MUX
GPIO0.int
XINT3
XINT3CR(15:0)
GPIO
MUX
GPIO31.int
XINT3CTR(15:0)
GPIOXINT3SEL(4:0)
TINT0
INT13
TINT1
INT14
TINT2
NMI
CPU TIMER 0
CPU TIMER 1
CPU TIMER 2
NMI interrupt with watchdog function
(See the NMI Watchdog section.)
CPUTMR2CLK
CLOCKFAIL
NMIRS
System Control
(See the System
Control section.)
Figure 3-5. External and PIE Interrupt Sources
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
41
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Eight PIE block interrupts are grouped into one CPU interrupt. In total, 12 CPU interrupt groups, with
8 interrupts per group equals 96 possible interrupts. Table 3-13 shows the interrupts used by 2803x
devices.
The TRAP #VectorNumber instruction transfers program control to the interrupt service routine
corresponding to the vector specified. TRAP #0 attempts to transfer program control to the address
pointed to by the reset vector. The PIE vector table does not, however, include a reset vector. Therefore,
TRAP #0 should not be used when the PIE is enabled. Doing so will result in undefined behavior.
When the PIE is enabled, TRAP #1 through TRAP #12 will transfer program control to the interrupt service
routine corresponding to the first vector within the PIE group. For example: TRAP #1 fetches the vector
from INT1.1, TRAP #2 fetches the vector from INT2.1, and so forth.
IFR[12:1]
IER[12:1]
INTM
INT1
INT2
1
CPU
MUX
0
INT11
INT12
(Flag)
INTx
INTx.1
INTx.2
INTx.3
INTx.4
INTx.5
INTx.6
INTx.7
INTx.8
MUX
PIEACKx
(Enable/Flag)
Global
Enable
(Enable)
(Enable)
(Flag)
PIEIERx[8:1]
PIEIFRx[8:1]
From
Peripherals
or
External
Interrupts
Figure 3-6. Multiplexing of Interrupts Using the PIE Block
42
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 3-13. PIE MUXed Peripheral Interrupt Vector Table (1)
INT1.y
INT2.y
INT3.y
INT4.y
INT5.y
INT6.y
INT7.y
INT8.y
INT9.y
INT10.y
INT11.y
INT12.y
(1)
INTx.8
INTx.7
INTx.6
INTx.5
INTx.4
INTx.3
INTx.2
INTx.1
WAKEINT
TINT0
ADCINT9
XINT2
XINT1
Reserved
ADCINT2
ADCINT1
(LPM/WD)
(TIMER 0)
(ADC)
Ext. int. 2
Ext. int. 1
–
(ADC)
(ADC)
0xD4E
0xD4C
0xD4A
0xD48
0xD46
0xD44
0xD42
0xD40
Reserved
EPWM7_TZINT
EPWM6_TZINT
EPWM5_TZINT
EPWM4_TZINT
EPWM3_TZINT
EPWM2_TZINT
EPWM1_TZINT
–
(ePWM7)
(ePWM6)
(ePWM5)
(ePWM4)
(ePWM3)
(ePWM2)
(ePWM1)
0xD5E
0xD5C
0xD5A
0xD58
0xD56
0xD54
0xD52
0xD50
Reserved
EPWM7_INT
EPWM6_INT
EPWM5_INT
EPWM4_INT
EPWM3_INT
EPWM2_INT
EPWM1_INT
(ePWM1)
–
(ePWM7)
(ePWM6)
(ePWM5)
(ePWM4)
(ePWM3)
(ePWM2)
0xD6E
0xD6C
0xD6A
0xD68
0xD66
0xD64
0xD62
0xD60
HRCAP2_INT
HRCAP1_INT
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
ECAP1_INT
(HRCAP2)
(HRCAP1)
–
–
–
–
–
(eCAP1)
0xD7E
0xD7C
0xD7A
0xD78
0xD76
0xD74
0xD72
0xD70
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
EQEP1_INT
(eQEP1)
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
0xD8E
0xD8C
0xD8A
0xD88
0xD86
0xD84
0xD82
0xD80
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
SPITXINTB
SPIRXINTB
SPITXINTA
SPIRXINTA
(SPI-A)
–
–
–
–
(SPI-B)
(SPI-B)
(SPI-A)
0xD9E
0xD9C
0xD9A
0xD98
0xD96
0xD94
0xD92
0xD90
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
0xDAE
0xDAC
0xDAA
0xDA8
0xDA6
0xDA4
0xDA2
0xDA0
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
I2CINT2A
I2CINT1A
–
–
–
–
–
–
(I2C-A)
(I2C-A)
0xDBE
0xDBC
0xDBA
0xDB8
0xDB6
0xDB4
0xDB2
0xDB0
Reserved
Reserved
ECAN1_INTA
ECAN0_INTA
LIN1_INTA
LIN0_INTA
SCITXINTA
SCIRXINTA
(SCI-A)
–
–
(CAN-A)
(CAN-A)
(LIN-A)
(LIN-A)
(SCI-A)
0xDCE
0xDCC
0xDCA
0xDC8
0xDC6
0xDC4
0xDC2
0xDC0
ADCINT8
ADCINT7
ADCINT6
ADCINT5
ADCINT4
ADCINT3
ADCINT2
ADCINT1
(ADC)
(ADC)
(ADC)
(ADC)
(ADC)
(ADC)
(ADC)
(ADC)
0xDDE
0xDDC
0xDDA
0xDD8
0xDD6
0xDD4
0xDD2
0xDD0
CLA1_INT8
CLA1_INT7
CLA1_INT6
CLA1_INT5
CLA1_INT4
CLA1_INT3
CLA1_INT2
CLA1_INT1
(CLA)
(CLA)
(CLA)
(CLA)
(CLA)
(CLA)
(CLA)
(CLA)
0xDEE
0xDEC
0xDEA
0xDE8
0xDE6
0xDE4
0xDE2
0xDE0
LUF
LVF
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
XINT3
(CLA)
(CLA)
–
–
–
–
–
Ext. Int. 3
0xDFE
0xDFC
0xDFA
0xDF8
0xDF6
0xDF4
0xDF2
0xDF0
Out of 96 possible interrupts, some interrupts are not used. These interrupts are reserved for future devices. These interrupts can be
used as software interrupts if they are enabled at the PIEIFRx level, provided none of the interrupts within the group is being used by a
peripheral. Otherwise, interrupts coming in from peripherals may be lost by accidentally clearing their flag while modifying the PIEIFR.
To summarize, there are two safe cases when the reserved interrupts could be used as software interrupts:
• No peripheral within the group is asserting interrupts.
• No peripheral interrupts are assigned to the group (for example, PIE group 7).
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
43
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Table 3-14. PIE Configuration and Control Registers
NAME
SIZE (x16)
PIECTRL
0x0CE0
1
PIE, Control Register
PIEACK
0x0CE1
1
PIE, Acknowledge Register
PIEIER1
0x0CE2
1
PIE, INT1 Group Enable Register
PIEIFR1
0x0CE3
1
PIE, INT1 Group Flag Register
PIEIER2
0x0CE4
1
PIE, INT2 Group Enable Register
PIEIFR2
0x0CE5
1
PIE, INT2 Group Flag Register
PIEIER3
0x0CE6
1
PIE, INT3 Group Enable Register
PIEIFR3
0x0CE7
1
PIE, INT3 Group Flag Register
PIEIER4
0x0CE8
1
PIE, INT4 Group Enable Register
PIEIFR4
0x0CE9
1
PIE, INT4 Group Flag Register
PIEIER5
0x0CEA
1
PIE, INT5 Group Enable Register
PIEIFR5
0x0CEB
1
PIE, INT5 Group Flag Register
PIEIER6
0x0CEC
1
PIE, INT6 Group Enable Register
PIEIFR6
0x0CED
1
PIE, INT6 Group Flag Register
PIEIER7
0x0CEE
1
PIE, INT7 Group Enable Register
PIEIFR7
0x0CEF
1
PIE, INT7 Group Flag Register
PIEIER8
0x0CF0
1
PIE, INT8 Group Enable Register
PIEIFR8
0x0CF1
1
PIE, INT8 Group Flag Register
PIEIER9
0x0CF2
1
PIE, INT9 Group Enable Register
PIEIFR9
0x0CF3
1
PIE, INT9 Group Flag Register
PIEIER10
0x0CF4
1
PIE, INT10 Group Enable Register
PIEIFR10
0x0CF5
1
PIE, INT10 Group Flag Register
PIEIER11
0x0CF6
1
PIE, INT11 Group Enable Register
PIEIFR11
0x0CF7
1
PIE, INT11 Group Flag Register
PIEIER12
0x0CF8
1
PIE, INT12 Group Enable Register
PIEIFR12
0x0CF9
1
PIE, INT12 Group Flag Register
Reserved
0x0CFA –
0x0CFF
6
Reserved
(1)
44
DESCRIPTION (1)
ADDRESS
The PIE configuration and control registers are not protected by EALLOW mode. The PIE vector table
is protected.
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
3.5.1
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
External Interrupts
Table 3-15. External Interrupt Registers
ADDRESS
SIZE (x16)
XINT1CR
NAME
0x00 7070
1
XINT1 configuration register
DESCRIPTION
XINT2CR
0x00 7071
1
XINT2 configuration register
XINT3CR
0x00 7072
1
XINT3 configuration register
XINT1CTR
0x00 7078
1
XINT1 counter register
XINT2CTR
0x00 7079
1
XINT2 counter register
XINT3CTR
0x00 707A
1
XINT3 counter register
Each external interrupt can be enabled/disabled or qualified using positive, negative, or both positive and
negative edge. For more information, see the TMS320x2803x Piccolo System Control and Interrupts
Reference Guide (literature number SPRUGL8).
3.6
VREG/BOR/POR
Although the core and I/O circuitry operate on two different voltages, these devices have an on-chip
voltage regulator (VREG) to generate the VDD voltage from the VDDIO supply. This eliminates the cost and
space of a second external regulator on an application board. Additionally, internal power-on reset (POR)
and brown-out reset (BOR) circuits monitor both the VDD and VDDIO rails during power-up and run mode.
3.6.1
On-chip Voltage Regulator (VREG)
A linear regulator generates the core voltage (VDD) from the VDDIO supply. Therefore, although capacitors
are required on each VDD pin to stabilize the generated voltage, power need not be supplied to these pins
to operate the device. Conversely, the VREG can be disabled, should power or redundancy be the
primary concern of the application.
3.6.1.1
Using the On-chip VREG
To utilize the on-chip VREG, the VREGENZ pin should be tied low and the appropriate recommended
operating voltage should be supplied to the VDDIO and VDDA pins. In this case, the VDD voltage needed by
the core logic will be generated by the VREG. Each VDD pin requires on the order of 1.2 μF (minimum)
capacitance for proper regulation of the VREG. These capacitors should be located as close as possible
to the VDD pins.
3.6.1.2
Disabling the On-chip VREG
To conserve power, it is also possible to disable the on-chip VREG and supply the core logic voltage to
the VDD pins with a more efficient external regulator. To enable this option, the VREGENZ pin must be tied
high.
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
45
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
3.6.2
www.ti.com
On-chip Power-On Reset (POR) and Brown-Out Reset (BOR) Circuit
Two on-chip supervisory circuits, the power-on reset (POR) and the brown-out reset (BOR) remove the
burden of monitoring the VDD and VDDIO supply rails from the application board. The purpose of the POR is
to create a clean reset throughout the device during the entire power-up procedure. The trip point is a
looser, lower trip point than the BOR, which watches for dips in the VDD or VDDIO rail during device
operation. The POR function is present on both VDD and VDDIO rails at all times. After initial device powerup, the BOR function is present on VDDIO at all times, and on VDD when the internal VREG is enabled
(VREGENZ pin is tied low). Both functions tie the XRS pin low when one of the voltages is below their
respective trip point. Additionally, when the internal voltage regulator is enabled, an over-voltage
protection circuit will tie XRS low if the VDD rail rises above its trip point. See Section 6 for the various trip
points as well as the delay time for the device to release the XRS pin after the under/over-voltage
condition is removed. Figure 3-7 shows the VREG, POR, and BOR. To disable both the VDD and VDDIO
BOR functions, a bit is provided in the BORCFG register. Refer to the TMS320x2803x Piccolo System
Control and Interrupts Reference Guide (literature number SPRUGL8) for details.
In
I/O Pin
Out
(Force Hi-Z When High)
DIR (0 = Input, 1 = Output)
SYSRS
Internal
Weak PU
SYSCLKOUT
Deglitch
Filter
XRS
Sync RS
MCLKRS
PLL
+
Clocking
Logic
XRS
Pin
C28
Core
JTAG
TCK
Detect
Logic
VREGHALT
(A)
WDRST
(B)
PBRS
A.
B.
POR/BOR
Generating
Module
On-Chip
Voltage
Regulator
(VREG)
VREGENZ
WDRST is the reset signal from the CPU-watchdog.
PBRS is the reset signal from the POR/BOR module.
Figure 3-7. VREG + POR + BOR + Reset Signal Connectivity
46
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
3.7
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
System Control
This section describes the oscillator and clocking mechanisms, the watchdog function and the low power
modes.
Table 3-16. PLL, Clocking, Watchdog, and Low-Power Mode Registers
NAME
DESCRIPTION (1)
ADDRESS
SIZE (x16)
BORCFG
0x00 0985
1
BOR Configuration Register
XCLK
0x00 7010
1
XCLKOUT Control
PLLSTS
0x00 7011
1
PLL Status Register
CLKCTL
0x00 7012
1
Clock Control Register
PLLLOCKPRD
0x00 7013
1
PLL Lock Period
INTOSC1TRIM
0x00 7014
1
Internal Oscillator 1 Trim Register
INTOSC2TRIM
0x00 7016
1
Internal Oscillator 2 Trim Register
LOSPCP
0x00 701B
1
Low-Speed Peripheral Clock Prescaler Register
PCLKCR0
0x00 701C
1
Peripheral Clock Control Register 0
PCLKCR1
0x00 701D
1
Peripheral Clock Control Register 1
LPMCR0
0x00 701E
1
Low Power Mode Control Register 0
PCLKCR3
0x00 7020
1
Peripheral Clock Control Register 3
PLLCR
0x00 7021
1
PLL Control Register
SCSR
0x00 7022
1
System Control and Status Register
WDCNTR
0x00 7023
1
Watchdog Counter Register
WDKEY
0x00 7025
1
Watchdog Reset Key Register
WDCR
0x00 7029
1
Watchdog Control Register
(1)
All registers in this table are EALLOW protected.
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
47
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Figure 3-8 shows the various clock domains that are discussed. Figure 3-9 shows the various clock
sources (both internal and external) that can provide a clock for device operation.
SYSCLKOUT
LOSPCP
(System Ctrl Regs)
PCLKCR0/1/3
(System Ctrl Regs)
Clock Enables
I/O
CLKIN
LSPCLK
SPI-A, SPI-B, SCI-A
Clock Enables
I/O
C28x Core
eCAN-A, LIN-A
Peripheral
Registers
PF2
/2
Peripheral
Registers
PF1
Peripheral
Registers
PF1
Peripheral
Registers
PF3
Peripheral
Registers
PF2
Clock Enables
GPIO
Mux
I/O
eCAP1, eQEP1, HRCAP1/2
Clock Enables
I/O
ePWM1/.../7, HRPWM1/.../7
Clock Enables
I/O
I2C-A
Clock Enables
16 Ch
ADC
Registers
PF2
PF0
Analog
GPIO
Mux
Clock Enables
6
A.
12-Bit ADC
COMP1/2/3
COMP
Registers
PF3
CLKIN is the clock into the CPU. It is passed out of the CPU as SYSCLKOUT (that is, CLKIN is the same frequency
as SYSCLKOUT).
Figure 3-8. Clock and Reset Domains
48
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
CLKCTL[WDCLKSRCSEL]
Internal
OSC 1
(10 MHz)
(A)
INTOSC1TRIM Reg
0
OSC1CLK
OSCCLKSRC1
WDCLK
CPU-Watchdog
(OSC1CLK on XRS reset)
OSCE
1
CLKCTL[INTOSC1OFF]
1 = Turn OSC Off
CLKCTL[OSCCLKSRCSEL]
CLKCTL[INTOSC1HALT]
WAKEOSC
1 = Ignore HALT
0
Internal OSC2CLK
OSC 2
(10 MHz)
(A)
INTOSC2TRIM Reg
OSCCLK
PLL
Missing-Clock-Detect Circuit
(OSC1CLK on XRS reset)
(B)
1
OSCE
CLKCTL[TRM2CLKPRESCALE]
CLKCTL[TMR2CLKSRCSEL]
1 = Turn OSC Off
10
CLKCTL[INTOSC2OFF]
11
1 = Ignore HALT
Prescale
/1, /2, /4,
/8, /16
01, 10, 11
CPUTMR2CLK
01
1
00
CLKCTL[INTOSC2HALT]
SYSCLKOUT
OSCCLKSRC2
0
0 = GPIO38
1 = GPIO19
XCLK[XCLKINSEL]
SYNC
Edge
Detect
CLKCTL[OSCCLKSRC2SEL]
CLKCTL[XCLKINOFF]
0
XCLKIN
GPIO19
or
GPIO38
1
0
XCLKIN
X1
EXTCLK
(Crystal)
OSC
XTAL
WAKEOSC
(Oscillators enabled when this signal is high)
X2
CLKCTL[XTALOSCOFF]
A.
B.
0 = OSC on (default on reset)
1 = Turn OSC off
Register loaded from TI OTP-based calibration function.
See Section 3.7.4 for details on missing clock detection.
Figure 3-9. Clock Tree
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
49
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
3.7.1
www.ti.com
Internal Zero Pin Oscillators
The F2803x devices contain two independent internal zero pin oscillators. By default both oscillators are
turned on at power up, and internal oscillator 1 is the default clock source at this time. For power savings,
unused oscillators may be powered down by the user. The center frequency of these oscillators is
determined by their respective oscillator trim registers, written to in the calibration routine as part of the
boot ROM execution. See Section 6, Electrical Specifications, for more information on these oscillators.
3.7.2
Crystal Oscillator Option
The typical specifications for the external quartz crystal (fundamental mode, parallel resonant) are listed in
Table 3-17. Furthermore, ESR range = 30 to 150 Ω.
Table 3-17. Typical Specifications for External Quartz Crystal (1)
(1)
FREQUENCY (MHz)
Rd (Ω)
CL1 (pF)
CL2 (pF)
5
2200
18
18
10
470
15
15
15
0
15
15
20
0
12
12
Cshunt should be less than or equal to 5 pF.
XCLKIN/GPIO19/38
Turn off
XCLKIN path
in CLKCTL
register
X1
X2
Rd
CL1
Crystal
CL2
Figure 3-10. Using the On-chip Crystal Oscillator
NOTE
1. CL1 and CL2 are the total capacitance of the circuit board and components excluding the
IC and crystal. The value is usually approximately twice the value of the crystal's load
capacitance.
2. The load capacitance of the crystal is described in the crystal specifications of the
manufacturers.
3. TI recommends that customers have the resonator/crystal vendor characterize the
operation of their device with the MCU chip. The resonator/crystal vendor has the
equipment and expertise to tune the tank circuit. The vendor can also advise the
customer regarding the proper tank component values that will produce proper start up
and stability over the entire operating range.
XCLKIN/GPIO19/38
External Clock Signal
(Toggling 0−VDDIO)
X1
X2
NC
Figure 3-11. Using a 3.3-V External Oscillator
50
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
3.7.3
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
PLL-Based Clock Module
The devices have an on-chip, PLL-based clock module. This module provides all the necessary clocking
signals for the device, as well as control for low-power mode entry. The PLL has a 4-bit ratio control
PLLCR[DIV] to select different CPU clock rates. The watchdog module should be disabled before writing
to the PLLCR register. It can be re-enabled (if need be) after the PLL module has stabilized, which takes
1 ms. The input clock and PLLCR[DIV] bits should be chosen in such a way that the output frequency of
the PLL (VCOCLK) is at least 50 MHz.
Table 3-18. PLL Settings
PLLCR[DIV] VALUE (1)
(1)
(2)
(3)
SYSCLKOUT (CLKIN)
(2)
PLLSTS[DIVSEL] = 0 or 1 (3)
PLLSTS[DIVSEL] = 2
PLLSTS[DIVSEL] = 3
0000 (PLL bypass)
OSCCLK/4 (Default) (1)
OSCCLK/2
OSCCLK
0001
(OSCCLK * 1)/4
(OSCCLK * 1)/2
(OSCCLK * 1)/1
0010
(OSCCLK * 2)/4
(OSCCLK * 2)/2
(OSCCLK * 2)/1
0011
(OSCCLK * 3)/4
(OSCCLK * 3)/2
(OSCCLK * 3)/1
0100
(OSCCLK * 4)/4
(OSCCLK * 4)/2
(OSCCLK * 4)/1
0101
(OSCCLK * 5)/4
(OSCCLK * 5)/2
(OSCCLK * 5)/1
0110
(OSCCLK * 6)/4
(OSCCLK * 6)/2
(OSCCLK * 6)/1
0111
(OSCCLK * 7)/4
(OSCCLK * 7)/2
(OSCCLK * 7)/1
1000
(OSCCLK * 8)/4
(OSCCLK * 8)/2
(OSCCLK * 8)/1
1001
(OSCCLK * 9)/4
(OSCCLK * 9)/2
(OSCCLK * 9)/1
1010
(OSCCLK * 10)/4
(OSCCLK * 10)/2
(OSCCLK * 10)/1
1011
(OSCCLK * 11)/4
(OSCCLK * 11)/2
(OSCCLK * 11)/1
1100
(OSCCLK * 12)/4
(OSCCLK * 12)/2
(OSCCLK * 12)/1
The PLL control register (PLLCR) and PLL Status Register (PLLSTS) are reset to their default state by the XRS signal or a watchdog
reset only. A reset issued by the debugger or the missing clock detect logic has no effect.
This register is EALLOW protected. See the TMS320x2803x Piccolo System Control and Interrupts Reference Guide (literature number
SPRUGL8) for more information.
By default, PLLSTS[DIVSEL] is configured for /4. (The boot ROM changes this to /1.) PLLSTS[DIVSEL] must be 0 before writing to the
PLLCR and should be changed only after PLLSTS[PLLLOCKS] = 1.
Table 3-19. CLKIN Divide Options
PLLSTS [DIVSEL]
CLKIN DIVIDE
0
/4
1
/4
2
/2
3
/1
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
51
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
The PLL-based clock module provides four modes of operation:
• INTOSC1 (Internal Zero-pin Oscillator 1): This is the on-chip internal oscillator 1. This can provide
the clock for the Watchdog block, core and CPU-Timer 2
• INTOSC2 (Internal Zero-pin Oscillator 2): This is the on-chip internal oscillator 2. This can provide
the clock for the Watchdog block, core and CPU-Timer 2. Both INTOSC1 and INTOSC2 can be
independently chosen for the Watchdog block, core and CPU-Timer 2.
• Crystal/Resonator Operation: The on-chip (crystal) oscillator enables the use of an external
crystal/resonator attached to the device to provide the time base. The crystal/resonator is connected to
the X1/X2 pins. Some devices may not have the X1/X2 pins. See Table 2-2 for details.
• External Clock Source Operation: If the on-chip (crystal) oscillator is not used, this mode allows it to
be bypassed. The device clocks are generated from an external clock source input on the XCLKIN pin.
Note that the XCLKIN is multiplexed with GPIO19 or GPIO38 pin. The XCLKIN input can be selected
as GPIO19 or GPIO38 via the XCLKINSEL bit in XCLK register. The CLKCTL[XCLKINOFF] bit
disables this clock input (forced low). If the clock source is not used or the respective pins are used as
GPIOs, the user should disable at boot time.
Before changing clock sources, ensure that the target clock is present. If a clock is not present, then that
clock source must be disabled (using the CLKCTL register) before switching clocks.
Table 3-20. Possible PLL Configuration Modes
REMARKS
PLLSTS[DIVSEL]
CLKIN AND
SYSCLKOUT
Invoked by the user setting the PLLOFF bit in the PLLSTS register. The PLL block
is disabled in this mode. This can be useful to reduce system noise and for low
power operation. The PLLCR register must first be set to 0x0000 (PLL Bypass)
before entering this mode. The CPU clock (CLKIN) is derived directly from the
input clock on either X1/X2, X1 or XCLKIN.
0, 1
2
3
OSCCLK/4
OSCCLK/2
OSCCLK/1
0, 1
2
3
OSCCLK/4
OSCCLK/2
OSCCLK/1
0, 1
2
3
OSCCLK * n/4
OSCCLK * n/2
OSCCLK * n/1
PLL MODE
PLL Off
PLL Bypass is the default PLL configuration upon power-up or after an external
reset (XRS). This mode is selected when the PLLCR register is set to 0x0000 or
PLL Bypass
while the PLL locks to a new frequency after the PLLCR register has been
modified. In this mode, the PLL itself is bypassed but the PLL is not turned off.
PLL Enable
3.7.4
Achieved by writing a non-zero value n into the PLLCR register. Upon writing to the
PLLCR the device will switch to PLL Bypass mode until the PLL locks.
Loss of Input Clock (NMI Watchdog Function)
The 2803x devices may be clocked from either one of the internal zero-pin oscillators
(INTOSC1/INTOSC2), the on-chip crystal oscillator, or from an external clock input. Regardless of the
clock source, in PLL-enabled and PLL-bypass mode, if the input clock to the PLL vanishes, the PLL will
issue a limp-mode clock at its output. This limp-mode clock continues to clock the CPU and peripherals at
a typical frequency of 1–5 MHz.
When the limp mode is activated, a CLOCKFAIL signal is generated that is latched as an NMI interrupt.
Depending on how the NMIRESETSEL bit has been configured, a reset to the device can be fired
immediately or the NMI watchdog counter can issue a reset when it overflows. In addition to this, the
Missing Clock Status (MCLKSTS) bit is set. The NMI interrupt could be used by the application to detect
the input clock failure and initiate necessary corrective action such as switching over to an alternative
clock source (if available) or initiate a shut-down procedure for the system.
If the software does not respond to the clock-fail condition, the NMI watchdog triggers a reset after a
preprogrammed time interval. Figure 3-12 shows the interrupt mechanisms involved.
52
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
NMIFLG[NMINT]
NMIFLGCLR[NMINT]
Clear
Latch
Set Clear
XRS
NMINT
Generate
Interrupt
Pulse
When
Input = 1
1
0
NMIFLG[CLOCKFAIL]
Clear
Latch
Clear Set
0
NMIFLGCLR[CLOCKFAIL]
CLOCKFAIL
SYNC?
SYSCLKOUT
NMICFG[CLOCKFAIL]
XRS
NMIFLGFRC[CLOCKFAIL]
SYSCLKOUT
SYSRS
NMIWDPRD[15:0]
NMIWDCNT[15:0]
NMI Watchdog
NMIRS
See System
Control Section
Figure 3-12. NMI-watchdog
3.7.5
CPU-Watchdog Module
The CPU-watchdog module on the 2803x device is similar to the one used on the 281x/280x/283xx
devices. This module generates an output pulse, 512 oscillator clocks wide (OSCCLK), whenever the 8-bit
watchdog up counter has reached its maximum value. To prevent this, the user must disable the counter
or the software must periodically write a 0x55 + 0xAA sequence into the watchdog key register that resets
the watchdog counter. Figure 3-13 shows the various functional blocks within the watchdog module.
Normally, when the input clocks are present, the CPU-watchdog counter decrements to initiate a CPUwatchdog reset or WDINT interrupt. However, when the external input clock fails, the CPU-watchdog
counter stops decrementing (that is, the watchdog counter does not change with the limp-mode clock).
NOTE
The CPU-watchdog is different from the NMI watchdog. It is the legacy watchdog that is
present in all 28x devices.
NOTE
Applications in which the correct CPU operating frequency is absolutely critical should
implement a mechanism by which the MCU will be held in reset, should the input clocks ever
fail. For example, an R-C circuit may be used to trigger the XRS pin of the MCU, should the
capacitor ever get fully charged. An I/O pin may be used to discharge the capacitor on a
periodic basis to prevent it from getting fully charged. Such a circuit would also help in
detecting failure of the flash memory.
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
53
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
WDCR (WDPS[2:0])
WDCR (WDDIS)
WDCNTR(7:0)
WDCLK
Watchdog
Prescaler
/512
WDCLK
8-Bit
Watchdog
Counter
CLR
Clear Counter
Internal
Pullup
WDKEY(7:0)
Watchdog
55 + AA
Key Detector
WDRST
Generate
Output Pulse
WDINT
(512 OSCCLKs)
Good Key
XRS
Core-reset
WDCR (WDCHK[2:0])
WDRST(A)
A.
1
0
Bad
WDCHK
Key
SCSR (WDENINT)
1
The WDRST signal is driven low for 512 OSCCLK cycles.
Figure 3-13. CPU-watchdog Module
The WDINT signal enables the watchdog to be used as a wakeup from IDLE/STANDBY mode.
In STANDBY mode, all peripherals are turned off on the device. The only peripheral that remains
functional is the CPU-watchdog. This module will run off OSCCLK. The WDINT signal is fed to the LPM
block so that it can wake the device from STANDBY (if enabled). See Section 3.8, Low-power Modes
Block, for more details.
In IDLE mode, the WDINT signal can generate an interrupt to the CPU, via the PIE, to take the CPU out of
IDLE mode.
In HALT mode, the CPU-watchdog can be used to wake up the device through a device reset.
54
Functional Overview
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
3.8
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Low-power Modes Block
Table 3-21 summarizes the various modes.
Table 3-21. Low-power Modes
EXIT (1)
MODE
LPMCR0(1:0)
OSCCLK
CLKIN
SYSCLKOUT
IDLE
00
On
On
On
XRS, CPU-watchdog interrupt, any
enabled interrupt
STANDBY
01
On
(CPU-watchdog still running)
Off
Off
XRS, CPU-watchdog interrupt, GPIO
Port A signal, debugger (2)
1X
Off
(on-chip crystal oscillator and
PLL turned off, zero-pin oscillator
and CPU-watchdog state
dependent on user code.)
Off
Off
XRS, GPIO Port A signal, debugger (2),
CPU-watchdog
HALT (3)
(1)
(2)
(3)
The Exit column lists which signals or under what conditions the low power mode is exited. A low signal, on any of the signals, exits the
low power condition. This signal must be kept low long enough for an interrupt to be recognized by the device. Otherwise, the low-power
mode will not be exited and the device will go back into the indicated low power mode.
The JTAG port can still function even if the CPU clock (CLKIN) is turned off.
The WDCLK must be active for the device to go into HALT mode.
The various low-power modes operate as follows:
IDLE Mode:
This mode is exited by any enabled interrupt that is recognized by the
processor. The LPM block performs no tasks during this mode as long as
the LPMCR0(LPM) bits are set to 0,0.
STANDBY Mode:
Any GPIO port A signal (GPIO[31:0]) can wake the device from STANDBY
mode. The user must select which signal(s) will wake the device in the
GPIOLPMSEL register. The selected signal(s) are also qualified by the
OSCCLK before waking the device. The number of OSCCLKs is specified in
the LPMCR0 register.
HALT Mode:
CPU-watchdog, XRS, and any GPIO port A signal (GPIO[31:0]) can wake
the device from HALT mode. The user selects the signal in the
GPIOLPMSEL register.
NOTE
The low-power modes do not affect the state of the output pins (PWM pins included). They
will be in whatever state the code left them in when the IDLE instruction was executed. See
the TMS320x2803x Piccolo System Control and Interrupts Reference Guide (literature
number SPRUGL8) for more details.
Functional Overview
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
55
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
4 Peripherals
4.1
Control Law Accelerator (CLA) Overview
The control law accelerator extends the capabilities of the C28x CPU by adding parallel processing. Timecritical control loops serviced by the CLA can achieve low ADC sample to output delay. Thus, the CLA
enables faster system response and higher frequency control loops. Utilizing the CLA for time-critical tasks
frees up the main CPU to perform other system and communication functions concurently. The following is
a list of major features of the CLA.
• Clocked at the same rate as the main CPU (SYSCLKOUT).
• An independent architecture allowing CLA algorithm execution independent of the main C28x CPU.
– Complete bus architecture:
• Program address bus and program data bus
• Data address bus, data read bus, and data write bus
– Independent eight-stage pipeline.
– 12-bit program counter (MPC)
– Four 32-bit result registers (MR0–MR3)
– Two 16-bit auxillary registers (MAR0, MAR1)
– Status register (MSTF)
• Instruction set includes:
– IEEE single-precision (32-bit) floating-point math operations
– Floating-point math with parallel load or store
– Floating-point multiply with parallel add or subtract
– 1/X and 1/sqrt(X) estimations
– Data type conversions.
– Conditional branch and call
– Data load/store operations
• The CLA program code can consist of up to eight tasks or interrupt service routines.
– The start address of each task is specified by the MVECT registers.
– No limit on task size as long as the tasks fit within the CLA program memory space.
– One task is serviced at a time through to completion. There is no nesting of tasks.
– Upon task completion, a task-specific interrupt is flagged within the PIE.
– When a task finishes, the next highest-priority pending task is automatically started.
• Task trigger mechanisms:
– C28x CPU via the IACK instruction
– Task1 to Task7: the corresponding ADC or ePWM module interrupt. For example:
• Task1: ADCINT1 or EPWM1_INT
• Task2: ADCINT2 or EPWM2_INT
• Task7: ADCINT7 or EPWM7_INT
– Task8: ADCINT8 or by CPU Timer 0.
• Memory and Shared Peripherals:
– Two dedicated message RAMs for communication between the CLA and the main CPU.
– The C28x CPU can map CLA program and data memory to the main CPU space or CLA space.
– The CLA has direct access to the ADC Result registers, comparator registers, and the
ePWM+HRPWM registers.
For more information on the CLA, see the TMS320x2803x Piccolo Control Law Accelerator (CLA)
Reference Guide (literature number SPRUGE6).
56
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
IACK
Peripheral Interrupts
CLA Control
Registers
CPU Timer 0
MIFR
MIOVF
MICLR
MICLROVF
MIFRC
MIER
MIRUN
MPERINT1
to
MPERINT8
MPISRCSEL1
CLA Program Address Bus
CLA
Program
Memory
CLA Program Data Bus
Main CPU BUS
Map to CLA or
CPU Space
SYSCLKOUT
CLAENCLK
SYSRS
INT11
INT12
PIE
MMEMCFG
Main CPU Read/Write Data Bus
CLA
Data
Memory
Map to CLA or
CPU Space
MCTL
MPC(12)
MSTF(32)
MR0(32)
MR1(32)
MR2(32)
MR3(32)
MAR0(32)
MAR1(32)
Main
28x
CPU
LVF
LUF
MVECT1
MVECT2
MVECT3
MVECT4
MVECT5
MVECT6
MVECT7
MVECT8
CLA Execution
Registers
Main CPU Read Data Bus
CLA_INT1 to CLA_INT8
CLA
Shared
Message
RAMs
MEALLOW
CLA Data Read Address Bus
CLA Data Read Data Bus
CLA Data Write Address Bus
CLA Data Bus
EPWM1_INT to
EPWM8_INT
INT
Main CPU Bus
ADCINT1 to
ADCINT8
ADC
Result
Registers
ePWM
and
HRPWM
Registers
CLA Data Write Data Bus
Comparator
Registers
Figure 4-1. CLA Block Diagram
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
57
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Table 4-1. CLA Control Registers
REGISTER NAME
CLA1
ADDRESS
SIZE (x16)
EALLOW
PROTECTED
MVECT1
0x1400
1
Yes
CLA Interrupt/Task 1 Start Address
MVECT2
0x1401
1
Yes
CLA Interrupt/Task 2 Start Address
MVECT3
0x1402
1
Yes
CLA Interrupt/Task 3 Start Address
MVECT4
0x1403
1
Yes
CLA Interrupt/Task 4 Start Address
MVECT5
0x1404
1
Yes
CLA Interrupt/Task 5 Start Address
MVECT6
0x1405
1
Yes
CLA Interrupt/Task 6 Start Address
MVECT7
0x1406
1
Yes
CLA Interrupt/Task 7 Start Address
MVECT8
0x1407
1
Yes
CLA Interrupt/Task 8 Start Address
MCTL
0x1410
1
Yes
CLA Control Register
MMEMCFG
0x1411
1
Yes
CLA Memory Configure Register
MPISRCSEL1
0x1414
2
Yes
Peripheral Interrupt Source Select Register 1
MIFR
0x1420
1
Yes
Interrupt Flag Register
MIOVF
0x1421
1
Yes
Interrupt Overflow Register
MIFRC
0x1422
1
Yes
Interrupt Force Register
MICLR
0x1423
1
Yes
Interrupt Clear Register
MICLROVF
0x1424
1
Yes
Interrupt Overflow Clear Register
MIER
0x1425
1
Yes
Interrupt Enable Register
MIRUN
0x1426
1
Yes
Interrupt RUN Register
MIPCTL
0x1427
1
Yes
Interrupt Priority Control Register
MPC
(2)
0x1428
1
–
CLA Program Counter
MAR0 (2)
0x142A
1
–
CLA Aux Register 0
MAR1 (2)
0x142B
1
–
CLA Aux Register 1
(2)
MSTF
0x142E
2
–
CLA STF Register
MR0 (2)
0x1430
2
–
CLA R0H Register
MR1 (2)
0x1434
2
–
CLA R1H Register
(2)
0x1438
2
–
CLA R2H Register
MR3 (2)
0x143C
2
–
CLA R3H Register
MR2
(1)
(2)
DESCRIPTION (1)
All registers in this table are CSM protected
The main C28x CPU has read only access to this register for debug purposes. The main CPU cannot perform CPU or debugger writes
to this register.
Table 4-2. CLA Message RAM
58
ADDRESS RANGE
SIZE (x16)
DESCRIPTION
0x1480 – 0x14FF
128
CLA to CPU Message RAM
0x1500 – 0x157F
128
CPU to CLA Message RAM
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
4.2
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Analog Block
A 12-bit ADC core is implemented that has different timings than the 12-bit ADC used on F280x/F2833x.
The ADC wrapper is modified to incorporate the new timings and also other enhancements to improve the
timing control of start of conversions. Figure 4-2 shows the interaction of the analog module with the rest
of the F2803x system.
For more information on the ADC, see the TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Analog-to-Digital Converter
(ADC) and Comparator Reference Guide (literature number SPRUGE5).
56-Pin
64-Pin
80-Pin
VDDA
VDDA
(3.3 V) VDDA
(Agnd) VSSA
VREFLO
VREFLO VSSA
Tied To
VSSA VREFLO
Interface Reference
Diff
VREFHI VREFHI
Tied To
A0
A0
A1
A2
A2
A3
A3
A4
A4
A5
A6
A6
A7
A7
B0
B0
B1
B1
B2
B2
B3
B3
B4
B4
B5
B6
B6
B7
B7
Signal Pinout
A1
B1
A2
Simultaneous Sampling Channels
A1
VREFHI
A0
B0
B2
COMP1OUT
AIO2
AIO10
10-Bit
DAC
Comp1
A3
B3
A4
B4
ADC
COMP2OUT
AIO4
AIO12
10-Bit
DAC
Comp2
B5
Temperature Sensor
A5
A6
B6
COMP3OUT
AIO6
AIO14
10-Bit
DAC
Comp3
A7
B7
Figure 4-2. Analog Pin Configurations
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
59
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
4.2.1
www.ti.com
ADC
4.2.1.1
Features
The core of the ADC contains a single 12-bit converter fed by two sample-and-hold circuits. The sampleand-hold circuits can be sampled simultaneously or sequentially. These, in turn, are fed by a total of up to
16 analog input channels. The converter can be configured to run with an internal bandgap reference to
create true-voltage based conversions or with a pair of external voltage references (VREFHI/VREFLO) to
create ratiometric-based conversions.
Contrary to previous ADC types, this ADC is not sequencer-based. It is easy for the user to create a
series of conversions from a single trigger. However, the basic principle of operation is centered around
the configurations of individual conversions, called SOCs, or Start-Of-Conversions.
Functions of the ADC module include:
• 12-bit ADC core with built-in dual sample-and-hold (S/H)
• Simultaneous sampling or sequential sampling modes
• Full range analog input: 0 V to 3.3 V fixed, or VREFHI/VREFLO ratiometric. The digital value of the input
analog voltage is derived by:
– Internal Reference (VREFLO = VSSA. VREFHI must not exceed VDDA when using either internal or
external reference modes.)
Digital Value = 0,
when input £ 0 V
Digital Value = 4096 ´
Input Analog Voltage - VREFLO
3.3
Digital Value = 4095,
when 0 V < input < 3.3 V
when input ³ 3.3 V
– External Reference (VREFHI/VREFLO connected to external references. VREFHI must not exceed VDDA
when using either internal or external reference modes.)
when input £ 0 V
Digital Value = 0,
Digital Value = 4096 ´
Digital Value = 4095,
•
•
•
•
•
60
Input Analog Voltage - VREFLO
VREFHI - VREFLO
when 0 V < input < VREFHI
when input ³ VREFHI
Up to 16-channel, multiplexed inputs
16 SOCs, configurable for trigger, sample window, and channel
16 result registers (individually addressable) to store conversion values
Multiple trigger sources
– S/W – software immediate start
– ePWM 1–7
– GPIO XINT2
– CPU Timers 0/1/2
– ADCINT1/2
9 flexible PIE interrupts, can configure interrupt request after any conversion
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 4-3. ADC Configuration and Control Registers
ADDRESS
SIZE
(x16)
EALLOW
PROTECTED
ADCCTL1
0x7100
1
Yes
Control 1 Register
ADCCTL2
0x7101
1
Yes
Control 2 Register
ADCINTFLG
0x7104
1
No
Interrupt Flag Register
ADCINTFLGCLR
0x7105
1
No
Interrupt Flag Clear Register
ADCINTOVF
0x7106
1
No
Interrupt Overflow Register
ADCINTOVFCLR
0x7107
1
No
Interrupt Overflow Clear Register
INTSEL1N2
0x7108
1
Yes
Interrupt 1 and 2 Selection Register
INTSEL3N4
0x7109
1
Yes
Interrupt 3 and 4 Selection Register
INTSEL5N6
0x710A
1
Yes
Interrupt 5 and 6 Selection Register
INTSEL7N8
0x710B
1
Yes
Interrupt 7 and 8 Selection Register
INTSEL9N10
0x710C
1
Yes
Interrupt 9 Selection Register (reserved Interrupt 10 Selection)
SOCPRICTL
0x7110
1
Yes
SOC Priority Control Register
ADCSAMPLEMODE
0x7112
1
Yes
Sampling Mode Register
ADCINTSOCSEL1
0x7114
1
Yes
Interrupt SOC Selection 1 Register (for 8 channels)
ADCINTSOCSEL2
0x7115
1
Yes
Interrupt SOC Selection 2 Register (for 8 channels)
ADCSOCFLG1
0x7118
1
No
SOC Flag 1 Register (for 16 channels)
ADCSOCFRC1
0x711A
1
No
SOC Force 1 Register (for 16 channels)
ADCSOCOVF1
0x711C
1
No
SOC Overflow 1 Register (for 16 channels)
ADCSOCOVFCLR1
0x711E
1
No
SOC Overflow Clear 1 Register (for 16 channels)
0x7120 –
0x712F
1
Yes
SOC0 Control Register to SOC15 Control Register
0x7140
1
Yes
Reference Trim Register
ADCOFFTRIM
0x7141
1
Yes
Offset Trim Register
COMPHYSTCTL
0x714C
1
Yes
Comparator Hysteresis Control Register
ADCREV
0x714F
1
No
Revision Register
REGISTER NAME
ADCSOC0CTL to
ADCSOC15CTL
ADCREFTRIM
DESCRIPTION
Table 4-4. ADC Result Registers (Mapped to PF0)
REGISTER NAME
ADCRESULT0 to
ADCRESULT15
ADDRESS
0xB00 –
0xB0F
SIZE
(x16)
EALLOW
PROTECTED
1
No
DESCRIPTION
ADC Result 0 Register to ADC Result 15 Register
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
61
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
0-Wait
Result
Registers
PF0 (CPU)
PF2 (CPU)
SYSCLKOUT
ADCENCLK
ADCINT 1
PIE
ADCINT 9
ADCTRIG 1
ADCTRIG 2
AIO
MUX
ADC
Channels
ADC
Core
12-Bit
ADCTRIG 3
ADCTRIG 4
ADCTRIG 5
ADCTRIG 6
ADCTRIG 7
ADCTRIG 8
ADCTRIG 9
ADCTRIG 10
ADCTRIG 11
ADCTRIG 12
ADCTRIG 13
ADCTRIG 14
ADCTRIG 15
ADCTRIG 16
ADCTRIG 17
ADCTRIG 18
TINT 0
TINT 1
TINT 2
XINT 2SOC
CPUTIMER 0
CPUTIMER 1
CPUTIMER 2
XINT 2
SOCA 1
SOCB 1
EPWM 1
SOCA 2
SOCB 2
EPWM 2
SOCA 3
SOCB 3
EPWM 3
SOCA 4
SOCB 4
EPWM 4
SOCA 5
SOCB 5
EPWM 5
SOCA 6
SOCB 6
EPWM 6
SOCA 7
SOCB 7
EPWM 7
Figure 4-3. ADC Connections
ADC Connections if the ADC is Not Used
It is recommended that the connections for the analog power pins be kept, even if the ADC is not used.
Following is a summary of how the ADC pins should be connected, if the ADC is not used in an
application:
• VDDA – Connect to VDDIO
• VSSA – Connect to VSS
• VREFLO – Connect to VSS
• ADCINAn, ADCINBn, VREFHI – Connect to VSSA
When the ADC module is used in an application, unused ADC input pins should be connected to analog
ground (VSSA).
NOTE: Unused ADCIN pins that are multiplexed with AIO function should not be directly connected to
analog ground. They should be grounded through a 1-kΩ resistor. This is to prevent an errant code from
configuring these pins as AIO outputs and driving grounded pins to a logic-high state.
When the ADC is not used, be sure that the clock to the ADC module is not turned on to realize power
savings.
62
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
4.2.2
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
ADC MUX
To COMPy A or B input
To ADC Channel X
Logic implemented in GPIO MUX block
AIOx Pin
SYSCLK
AIOxIN
1
AIOxINE
AIODAT Reg
(Read)
SYNC
0
AIODAT Reg
(Latch)
AIOxDIR
(1 = Input,
0 = Output)
AIOMUX 1 Reg
AIOSET,
AIOCLEAR,
AIOTOGGLE
Regs
AIODIR Reg
(Latch)
1
(0 = Input, 1 = Output)
0
0
Figure 4-4. AIOx Pin Multiplexing
The ADC channel and Comparator functions are always available. The digital I/O function is available only
when the respective bit in the AIOMUX1 register is 0. In this mode, reading the AIODAT register reflects
the actual pin state.
The digital I/O function is disabled when the respective bit in the AIOMUX1 register is 1. In this mode,
reading the AIODAT register reflects the output latch of the AIODAT register and the input digital I/O buffer
is disabled to prevent analog signals from generating noise.
On reset, the digital function is disabled. If the pin is used as an analog input, users should keep the AIO
function disabled for that pin.
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
63
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
4.2.3
www.ti.com
Comparator Block
Figure 4-5 shows the interaction of the Comparator modules with the rest of the system.
COMP x A
COMP x B
+
COMP
-
GPIO
MUX
COMP x
+
DAC x
Wrapper
AIO
MUX
TZ1/2/3
ePWM
COMPxOUT
DAC
Core
10-Bit
Figure 4-5. Comparator Block Diagram
Table 4-5. Comparator Control Registers
REGISTER
NAME
COMP1
ADDRESS
COMP2
ADDRESS
COMP3
ADDRESS
SIZE
(x16)
EALLOW
PROTECTED
COMPCTL
0x6400
0x6420
0x6440
1
Yes
Comparator Control Register
COMPSTS
0x6402
0x6422
0x6442
1
No
Comparator Status Register
DACCTL
0x6404
0x6424
0x6444
1
Yes
DAC Control Register
DACVAL
0x6406
0x6426
0x6446
1
No
DAC Value Register
RAMPMAXREF_
ACTIVE
0x6408
0x6428
0x6448
1
No
Ramp Generator Maximum Reference
(Active) Register
RAMPMAXREF_
SHDW
0x640A
0x642A
0x644A
1
No
Ramp Generator Maximum Reference
(Shadow) Register
RAMPDECVAL_
ACTIVE
0x640C
0x642C
0x644C
1
No
Ramp Generator Decrement Value (Active)
Register
RAMPDECVAL_
SHDW
0x640E
0x642E
0x644E
1
No
Ramp Generator Decrement Value
(Shadow) Register
RAMPSTS
0x6410
0x6430
0x6450
1
No
Ramp Generator Status Register
64
Peripherals
DESCRIPTION
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
4.3
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Module
The device includes the four-pin serial peripheral interface (SPI) module. Up to two SPI modules are
available. The SPI is a high-speed, synchronous serial I/O port that allows a serial bit stream of
programmed length (one to sixteen bits) to be shifted into and out of the device at a programmable bittransfer rate. Normally, the SPI is used for communications between the MCU and external peripherals or
another processor. Typical applications include external I/O or peripheral expansion through devices such
as shift registers, display drivers, and ADCs. Multidevice communications are supported by the
master/slave operation of the SPI.
The SPI module features include:
• Four external pins:
– SPISOMI: SPI slave-output/master-input pin
– SPISIMO: SPI slave-input/master-output pin
– SPISTE: SPI slave transmit-enable pin
– SPICLK: SPI serial-clock pin
NOTE: All four pins can be used as GPIO if the SPI module is not used.
• Two operational modes: master and slave
Baud rate: 125 different programmable rates.
•
•
•
•
•
Baud rate =
LSPCLK
(SPIBRR + 1)
when SPIBRR = 3 to 127
Baud rate =
LSPCLK
4
when SPIBRR = 0, 1, 2
Data word length: one to sixteen data bits
Four clocking schemes (controlled by clock polarity and clock phase bits) include:
– Falling edge without phase delay: SPICLK active-high. SPI transmits data on the falling edge of the
SPICLK signal and receives data on the rising edge of the SPICLK signal.
– Falling edge with phase delay: SPICLK active-high. SPI transmits data one half-cycle ahead of the
falling edge of the SPICLK signal and receives data on the falling edge of the SPICLK signal.
– Rising edge without phase delay: SPICLK inactive-low. SPI transmits data on the rising edge of the
SPICLK signal and receives data on the falling edge of the SPICLK signal.
– Rising edge with phase delay: SPICLK inactive-low. SPI transmits data one half-cycle ahead of the
falling edge of the SPICLK signal and receives data on the rising edge of the SPICLK signal.
Simultaneous receive and transmit operation (transmit function can be disabled in software)
Transmitter and receiver operations are accomplished through either interrupt-driven or polled
algorithms.
Nine SPI module control registers: Located in control register frame beginning at address 7040h.
NOTE
All registers in this module are 16-bit registers that are connected to Peripheral Frame 2.
When a register is accessed, the register data is in the lower byte (7–0), and the upper byte
(15–8) is read as zeros. Writing to the upper byte has no effect.
Enhanced feature:
• 4-level transmit/receive FIFO
• Delayed transmit control
• Bi-directional 3 wire SPI mode support
• Audio data receive support via SPISTE inversion
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
65
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
The SPI port operation is configured and controlled by the registers listed in Table 4-6 and Table 4-7.
Table 4-6. SPI-A Registers
(1)
DESCRIPTION (1)
NAME
ADDRESS
SIZE (x16)
EALLOW PROTECTED
SPICCR
0x7040
1
No
SPI-A Configuration Control Register
SPICTL
0x7041
1
No
SPI-A Operation Control Register
SPISTS
0x7042
1
No
SPI-A Status Register
SPIBRR
0x7044
1
No
SPI-A Baud Rate Register
SPIRXEMU
0x7046
1
No
SPI-A Receive Emulation Buffer Register
SPIRXBUF
0x7047
1
No
SPI-A Serial Input Buffer Register
SPITXBUF
0x7048
1
No
SPI-A Serial Output Buffer Register
SPIDAT
0x7049
1
No
SPI-A Serial Data Register
SPIFFTX
0x704A
1
No
SPI-A FIFO Transmit Register
SPIFFRX
0x704B
1
No
SPI-A FIFO Receive Register
SPIFFCT
0x704C
1
No
SPI-A FIFO Control Register
SPIPRI
0x704F
1
No
SPI-A Priority Control Register
Registers in this table are mapped to Peripheral Frame 2. This space only allows 16-bit accesses. 32-bit accesses produce undefined
results.
Table 4-7. SPI-B Registers
(1)
DESCRIPTION (1)
NAME
ADDRESS
SIZE (x16)
EALLOW PROTECTED
SPICCR
0x7740
1
No
SPI-B Configuration Control Register
SPICTL
0x7741
1
No
SPI-B Operation Control Register
SPISTS
0x7742
1
No
SPI-B Status Register
SPIBRR
0x7744
1
No
SPI-B Baud Rate Register
SPIRXEMU
0x7746
1
No
SPI-B Receive Emulation Buffer Register
SPIRXBUF
0x7747
1
No
SPI-B Serial Input Buffer Register
SPITXBUF
0x7748
1
No
SPI-B Serial Output Buffer Register
SPIDAT
0x7749
1
No
SPI-B Serial Data Register
SPIFFTX
0x774A
1
No
SPI-B FIFO Transmit Register
SPIFFRX
0x774B
1
No
SPI-B FIFO Receive Register
SPIFFCT
0x774C
1
No
SPI-B FIFO Control Register
SPIPRI
0x774F
1
No
SPI-B Priority Control Register
Registers in this table are mapped to Peripheral Frame 2. This space only allows 16-bit accesses. 32-bit accesses produce undefined
results.
For more information on the SPI, see the TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
Reference Guide (literature number SPRUG71).
66
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Figure 4-6 is a block diagram of the SPI in slave mode.
SPIFFENA
SPIFFTX.14
Receiver
Overrun Flag
RX FIFO Registers
SPISTS.7
Overrun
INT ENA
SPICTL.4
SPIRXBUF
RX FIFO _0
RX FIFO _1
-----
SPIINT
RX FIFO Interrupt
RX FIFO _3
RX Interrupt
Logic
16
SPIRXBUF
Buffer Register
SPIFFOVF
FLAG
SPIFFRX.15
To CPU
TX FIFO Registers
SPITXBUF
TX FIFO _3
SPITX
16
16
TX Interrupt
Logic
TX FIFO Interrupt
----TX FIFO _1
TX FIFO _0
SPI INT
ENA
SPI INT FLAG
SPITXBUF
Buffer Register
SPISTS.6
SPICTL.0
TRIWIRE
SPIPRI.0
16
M
M
SPIDAT
Data Register
TW
S
S
SPIDAT.15 - 0
SW1
SPISIMO
M TW
M
TW
SPISOMI
S
S
STEINV
SW2
SPIPRI.1
Talk
STEINV
SPICTL.1
SPISTE
State Control
Master/Slave
SPICCR.3 - 0
SPI Char
3
2
M
SPI Bit Rate
SW3
S
SPIBRR.6 - 0
LSPCLK
6
A.
SPICTL.2
S
0
1
5
4
3
2
1
Clock
Polarity
Clock
Phase
SPICCR.6
SPICTL.3
SPICLK
M
0
SPISTE is driven low by the master for a slave device.
Figure 4-6. SPI Module Block Diagram (Slave Mode)
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
67
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
4.4
www.ti.com
Serial Communications Interface (SCI) Module
The devices include one serial communications interface (SCI) module (SCI-A). The SCI module supports
digital communications between the CPU and other asynchronous peripherals that use the standard nonreturn-to-zero (NRZ) format. The SCI receiver and transmitter are double-buffered, and each has its own
separate enable and interrupt bits. Both can be operated independently or simultaneously in the fullduplex mode. To ensure data integrity, the SCI checks received data for break detection, parity, overrun,
and framing errors. The bit rate is programmable to over 65000 different speeds through a 16-bit baudselect register.
Features of each SCI module include:
• Two external pins:
– SCITXD: SCI transmit-output pin
– SCIRXD: SCI receive-input pin
NOTE: Both pins can be used as GPIO if not used for SCI.
– Baud rate programmable to 64K different rates:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Baud rate =
LSPCLK
(BRR + 1) * 8
when BRR ¹ 0
Baud rate =
LSPCLK
16
when BRR = 0
Data-word format
– One start bit
– Data-word length programmable from one to eight bits
– Optional even/odd/no parity bit
– One or two stop bits
Four error-detection flags: parity, overrun, framing, and break detection
Two wake-up multiprocessor modes: idle-line and address bit
Half- or full-duplex operation
Double-buffered receive and transmit functions
Transmitter and receiver operations can be accomplished through interrupt-driven or polled algorithms
with status flags.
– Transmitter: TXRDY flag (transmitter-buffer register is ready to receive another character) and TX
EMPTY flag (transmitter-shift register is empty)
– Receiver: RXRDY flag (receiver-buffer register is ready to receive another character), BRKDT flag
(break condition occurred), and RX ERROR flag (monitoring four interrupt conditions)
Separate enable bits for transmitter and receiver interrupts (except BRKDT)
NRZ (non-return-to-zero) format
NOTE
All registers in this module are 8-bit registers that are connected to Peripheral Frame 2.
When a register is accessed, the register data is in the lower byte (7–0), and the upper byte
(15–8) is read as zeros. Writing to the upper byte has no effect.
Enhanced features:
• Auto baud-detect hardware logic
• 4-level transmit/receive FIFO
68
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
The SCI port operation is configured and controlled by the registers listed in Table 4-8.
Table 4-8. SCI-A Registers (1)
NAME
ADDRESS
SIZE (x16)
EALLOW
PROTECTED
SCICCRA
0x7050
1
No
SCI-A Communications Control Register
SCICTL1A
0x7051
1
No
SCI-A Control Register 1
SCIHBAUDA
0x7052
1
No
SCI-A Baud Register, High Bits
SCILBAUDA
0x7053
1
No
SCI-A Baud Register, Low Bits
SCICTL2A
0x7054
1
No
SCI-A Control Register 2
SCIRXSTA
0x7055
1
No
SCI-A Receive Status Register
SCIRXEMUA
0x7056
1
No
SCI-A Receive Emulation Data Buffer Register
SCIRXBUFA
0x7057
1
No
SCI-A Receive Data Buffer Register
SCITXBUFA
0x7059
1
No
SCI-A Transmit Data Buffer Register
(2)
0x705A
1
No
SCI-A FIFO Transmit Register
SCIFFRXA (2)
0x705B
1
No
SCI-A FIFO Receive Register
SCIFFCTA (2)
0x705C
1
No
SCI-A FIFO Control Register
SCIPRIA
0x705F
1
No
SCI-A Priority Control Register
SCIFFTXA
(1)
(2)
DESCRIPTION
Registers in this table are mapped to Peripheral Frame 2 space. This space only allows 16-bit accesses. 32-bit accesses produce
undefined results.
These registers are new registers for the FIFO mode.
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
69
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
For more information on the SCI, see the TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Serial Communications Interface
(SCI) Reference Guide (literature number SPRUGH1).
Figure 4-7 shows the SCI module block diagram.
SCICTL1.1
SCITXD
Frame Format and Mode
Parity
Even/Odd Enable
TXSHF
Register
TXENA
8
SCICCR.6 SCICCR.5
TX EMPTY
SCICTL2.6
TXRDY
TXWAKE
SCICTL1.3
1
Transmitter-Data
Buffer Register
8
TX INT ENA
SCICTL2.7
SCICTL2.0
TX FIFO
Interrupts
TX FIFO _0
TX FIFO _1
TXINT
TX Interrupt
Logic
To CPU
-----
TX FIFO _3
WUT
SCITXD
SCI TX Interrupt select logic
SCITXBUF.7-0
TX FIFO registers
SCIFFENA
AutoBaud Detect logic
SCIFFTX.14
SCIHBAUD. 15 - 8
Baud Rate
MSbyte
Register
SCIRXD
RXSHF
Register
SCIRXD
RXWAKE
LSPCLK
SCIRXST.1
SCILBAUD. 7 - 0
Baud Rate
LSbyte
Register
RXENA
8
SCICTL1.0
SCICTL2.1
Receive Data
Buffer register
SCIRXBUF.7-0
RXRDY
SCIRXST.6
8
BRKDT
RX FIFO _3
-----
RX FIFO_1
RX FIFO _0
SCIRXBUF.7-0
RX/BK INT ENA
RX FIFO
Interrupts
SCIRXST.5
RX Interrupt
Logic
RX FIFO registers
SCIRXST.7
SCIRXST.4 - 2
RX Error
FE OE PE
RXINT
To CPU
RXFFOVF
SCIFFRX.15
RX Error
RX ERR INT ENA
SCICTL1.6
SCI RX Interrupt select logic
Figure 4-7. Serial Communications Interface (SCI) Module Block Diagram
70
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
4.5
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Local Interconnect Network (LIN)
The device contains one LIN controller. The LIN standard is based on the SCI (UART) serial data link
format. The LIN module can be configured to work as a SCI as well.
The LIN module has the following features:
• Compatible to LIN 1.3 or 2.0 protocols
• Two external pins: LINRX and LINTX
• Multi-buffered receive and transmit units
• Identification masks for message filtering
• Automatic master header generation
– Programmable sync break field
– Sync field
– Identifier field
• Slave automatic synchronization
– Sync break detection
– Optional baudrate update
– Synchronization validation
• 231 programmable transmission rates with 7 fractional bits
• Wakeup on LINRX dominant level from transceiver
• Automatic wakeup support
– Wakeup signal generation
– Expiration times on wakeup signals
• Automatic bus idle detection
• Error detection
– Bit error
– Bus error
– No-response error
– Checksum error
– Sync field error
– Parity error
• 2 Interrupt lines with priority encoding for:
– Receive
– Transmit
– ID, error and status
NOTE
The 2803x devices have passed LIN 2.0 conformance tests (master and slave). Contact TI
for details.
For more information on the LIN, see the TMS320F2803x Piccolo Local Interconnect Network (LIN)
Module User's Guide (literature number SPRUGE2).
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
71
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
The registers in Table 4-9 configure and control the operation of the LIN module.
Table 4-9. LIN-A Registers (1)
(1)
72
NAME
ADDRESS
SIZE (x16)
SCIGCR0
0x6C00
2
Global Control Register 0
DESCRIPTION
SCIGCR1
0x6C02
2
Global Control Register 1
SCIGCR2
0x6C04
2
Global Control Register 2
SCISETINT
0x6C06
2
Interrupt Enable Register
SCICLEARINT
0x6C08
2
Interrupt Disable Register
SCISETINTLVL
0x6C0A
2
Set Interrupt Level Register
SCICLEARINTLVL
0x6C0C
2
Clear Interrupt Level Register
SCIFLR
0x6C0E
2
Flag Register
SCIINTVECT0
0x6C10
2
Interrupt Vector Offset Register 0
SCIINTVECT1
0x6C12
2
Interrupt Vector Offset Register 1
SCIFORMAT
0x6C14
2
Length Control register
BRSR
0x6C16
2
Baud Rate Selection Register
SCIED
0x6C18
2
Emulation buffer register
SCIRD
0x6C1A
2
Receiver data buffer register
SCITD
0x6C1C
2
Transmit data buffer register
Reserved
0x6C1E
4
RSVD
SIPIO2
0x6C22
2
Pin control register 2
Reserved
0x6C24
10
RSVD
LINCOMP
0x6C30
2
Compare register
LINRD0
0x6C32
2
Receive data register 0
LINRD1
0x6C34
2
Receive data register 1
LINMASK
0x6C36
2
Acceptance mask register
LINID
0x6C38
2
Register containing ID- byte, ID-SlaveTask byte, and ID
received fields.
LINTD0
0x6C3A
2
Transmit Data Register 0
LINTD1
0x6C3C
2
Transmit Data Register 1
MBRSR
0x6C3E
2
Baud Rate Selection Register
Reserved
0x6C40
8
RSVD
IODFTCTRL
0x6C48
2
IODFT for BLIN
Some registers and some bits in other registers are EALLOW-protected. See the TMS320x2803x Piccolo Local Interconnect Network
(LIN) Module Reference Guide (literature number SPRUGE2) for more details.
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Figure 4-8 shows the LIN module block diagram.
READ DATA BUS
WRITE DATA BUS
ADDRESS BUS
CHECKSUM
CALCULATOR
INTERFACE
ID PARTY
CHECKER
BIT
MONITOR
TXRX ERROR
DETECTOR (TED)
TIMEOUT
CONTROL
COUNTER
LINRX/
SCIRX
COMPARE
LINTX/
SCITX
FSM
MASK
FILTER
SYNCHRONIZER
8 RECEIVE
BUFFERS
8 TRANSMIT
BUFFERS
Figure 4-8. LIN Block Diagram
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
73
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
4.6
www.ti.com
Enhanced Controller Area Network (eCAN) Module
The CAN module (eCAN-A) has the following features:
• Fully compliant with CAN protocol, version 2.0B
• Supports data rates up to 1 Mbps
• Thirty-two mailboxes, each with the following properties:
– Configurable as receive or transmit
– Configurable with standard or extended identifier
– Has a programmable receive mask
– Supports data and remote frame
– Composed of 0 to 8 bytes of data
– Uses a 32-bit time stamp on receive and transmit message
– Protects against reception of new message
– Holds the dynamically programmable priority of transmit message
– Employs a programmable interrupt scheme with two interrupt levels
– Employs a programmable alarm on transmission or reception time-out
• Low-power mode
• Programmable wake-up on bus activity
• Automatic reply to a remote request message
• Automatic retransmission of a frame in case of loss of arbitration or error
• 32-bit local network time counter synchronized by a specific message (communication in conjunction
with mailbox 16)
• Self-test mode
– Operates in a loopback mode receiving its own message. A "dummy" acknowledge is provided,
thereby eliminating the need for another node to provide the acknowledge bit.
NOTE
For a SYSCLKOUT of 60 MHz, the smallest bit rate possible is 4.6875 kbps.
The F2803x CAN has passed the conformance test per ISO/DIS 16845. Contact TI for test report and
exceptions.
For information on using the CAN module with the on-chip zero-pin oscillators, see the Piccolo MCU CAN
Module Operation Using the On-Chip Zero-Pin Oscillator Application Report (literature number SPRABI7).
For more information on the CAN, see the TMS320x2803x Piccolo Enhanced Controller Area Network
(eCAN) Reference Guide (literature number SPRUGL7).
74
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
eCAN0INT
eCAN1INT
Controls Address
Data
Enhanced CAN Controller
32
Message Controller
Mailbox RAM
(512 Bytes)
Memory Management
Unit
32-Message Mailbox
of 4 x 32-Bit Words
32
CPU Interface,
Receive Control Unit,
Timer Management Unit
32
eCAN Memory
(512 Bytes)
Registers and
Message Objects Control
32
eCAN Protocol Kernel
Receive Buffer
Transmit Buffer
Control Buffer
Status Buffer
SN65HVD23x
3.3-V CAN Transceiver
CAN Bus
Figure 4-9. eCAN Block Diagram and Interface Circuit
Table 4-10. 3.3-V eCAN Transceivers
PART NUMBER
SUPPLY
VOLTAGE
LOW-POWER
MODE
SLOPE
CONTROL
VREF
OTHER
TA
SN65HVD230
3.3 V
Standby
Adjustable
Yes
–
–40°C to 85°C
SN65HVD230Q
3.3 V
Standby
Adjustable
Yes
–
–40°C to 125°C
SN65HVD231
3.3 V
Sleep
Adjustable
Yes
–
–40°C to 85°C
SN65HVD231Q
3.3 V
Sleep
Adjustable
Yes
–
–40°C to 125°C
SN65HVD232
3.3 V
None
None
None
–
–40°C to 85°C
SN65HVD232Q
3.3 V
None
None
None
–
–40°C to 125°C
SN65HVD233
3.3 V
Standby
Adjustable
None
Diagnostic Loopback
–40°C to 125°C
SN65HVD234
3.3 V
Standby and Sleep
Adjustable
None
–
–40°C to 125°C
SN65HVD235
3.3 V
Standby
Adjustable
None
Autobaud Loopback
–40°C to 125°C
ISO1050
3–5.5 V
None
None
None
Built-in Isolation
Low Prop Delay
Thermal Shutdown
Failsafe Operation
Dominant Time-Out
–55°C to 105°C
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
75
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
eCAN-A Control and Status Registers
Mailbox Enable - CANME
Mailbox Direction - CANMD
Transmission Request Set - CANTRS
Transmission Request Reset - CANTRR
Transmission Acknowledge - CANTA
Abort Acknowledge - CANAA
eCAN-A Memory (512 Bytes)
6000h
Received Message Pending - CANRMP
Control and Status Registers
603Fh
6040h
607Fh
6080h
60BFh
60C0h
60FFh
Received Message Lost - CANRML
Remote Frame Pending - CANRFP
Local Acceptance Masks (LAM)
(32 x 32-Bit RAM)
Global Acceptance Mask - CANGAM
Message Object Time Stamps (MOTS)
(32 x 32-Bit RAM)
Bit-Timing Configuration - CANBTC
Message Object Time-Out (MOTO)
(32 x 32-Bit RAM)
Transmit Error Counter - CANTEC
Master Control - CANMC
Error and Status - CANES
Receive Error Counter - CANREC
Global Interrupt Flag 0 - CANGIF0
Global Interrupt Mask - CANGIM
Global Interrupt Flag 1 - CANGIF1
eCAN-A Memory RAM (512 Bytes)
6100h-6107h
Mailbox 0
6108h-610Fh
Mailbox 1
6110h-6117h
Mailbox 2
6118h-611Fh
Mailbox 3
6120h-6127h
Mailbox 4
Mailbox Interrupt Mask - CANMIM
Mailbox Interrupt Level - CANMIL
Overwrite Protection Control - CANOPC
TX I/O Control - CANTIOC
RX I/O Control - CANRIOC
Time Stamp Counter - CANTSC
Time-Out Control - CANTOC
Time-Out Status - CANTOS
61E0h-61E7h
Mailbox 28
61E8h-61EFh
Mailbox 29
61F0h-61F7h
Mailbox 30
61F8h-61FFh
Mailbox 31
Reserved
Message Mailbox (16 Bytes)
61E8h-61E9h
Message Identifier - MSGID
61EAh-61EBh
Message Control - MSGCTRL
61ECh-61EDh
Message Data Low - MDL
61EEh-61EFh
Message Data High - MDH
Figure 4-10. eCAN-A Memory Map
NOTE
If the eCAN module is not used in an application, the RAM available (LAM, MOTS, MOTO,
and mailbox RAM) can be used as general-purpose RAM. The CAN module clock should be
enabled for this.
76
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
The CAN registers listed in Table 4-11 are used by the CPU to configure and control the CAN controller
and the message objects. eCAN control registers only support 32-bit read/write operations. Mailbox RAM
can be accessed as 16 bits or 32 bits. 32-bit accesses are aligned to an even boundary.
Table 4-11. CAN Register Map (1)
(1)
REGISTER NAME
eCAN-A
ADDRESS
SIZE (x32)
DESCRIPTION
CANME
0x6000
1
Mailbox enable
CANMD
0x6002
1
Mailbox direction
CANTRS
0x6004
1
Transmit request set
CANTRR
0x6006
1
Transmit request reset
CANTA
0x6008
1
Transmission acknowledge
CANAA
0x600A
1
Abort acknowledge
CANRMP
0x600C
1
Receive message pending
CANRML
0x600E
1
Receive message lost
CANRFP
0x6010
1
Remote frame pending
CANGAM
0x6012
1
Global acceptance mask
CANMC
0x6014
1
Master control
CANBTC
0x6016
1
Bit-timing configuration
CANES
0x6018
1
Error and status
CANTEC
0x601A
1
Transmit error counter
CANREC
0x601C
1
Receive error counter
CANGIF0
0x601E
1
Global interrupt flag 0
CANGIM
0x6020
1
Global interrupt mask
CANGIF1
0x6022
1
Global interrupt flag 1
CANMIM
0x6024
1
Mailbox interrupt mask
CANMIL
0x6026
1
Mailbox interrupt level
CANOPC
0x6028
1
Overwrite protection control
CANTIOC
0x602A
1
TX I/O control
CANRIOC
0x602C
1
RX I/O control
CANTSC
0x602E
1
Time stamp counter (Reserved in SCC mode)
CANTOC
0x6030
1
Time-out control (Reserved in SCC mode)
CANTOS
0x6032
1
Time-out status (Reserved in SCC mode)
These registers are mapped to Peripheral Frame 1.
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
77
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
4.7
www.ti.com
Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C)
The device contains one I2C Serial Port. Figure 4-11 shows how the I2C peripheral module interfaces
within the device.
The I2C module has the following features:
• Compliance with the Philips Semiconductors I2C-bus specification (version 2.1):
– Support for 1-bit to 8-bit format transfers
– 7-bit and 10-bit addressing modes
– General call
– START byte mode
– Support for multiple master-transmitters and slave-receivers
– Support for multiple slave-transmitters and master-receivers
– Combined master transmit/receive and receive/transmit mode
– Data transfer rate of from 10 kbps up to 400 kbps (I2C Fast-mode rate)
• One 4-word receive FIFO and one 4-word transmit FIFO
• One interrupt that can be used by the CPU. This interrupt can be generated as a result of one of the
following conditions:
– Transmit-data ready
– Receive-data ready
– Register-access ready
– No-acknowledgment received
– Arbitration lost
– Stop condition detected
– Addressed as slave
• An additional interrupt that can be used by the CPU when in FIFO mode
• Module enable/disable capability
• Free data format mode
For more information on the I2C, see the TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C)
Module Reference Guide (literature number SPRUFZ9).
78
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
2
I C Module
I2CXSR
I2CDXR
TX FIFO
FIFO Interrupt to
CPU/PIE
SDA
RX FIFO
Peripheral Bus
I2CRSR
SCL
I2CDRR
Clock
Synchronizer
Control/Status
Registers
CPU
Prescaler
Noise Filters
Interrupt to
CPU/PIE
I2C INT
Arbitrator
A.
B.
The I2C registers are accessed at the SYSCLKOUT rate. The internal timing and signal waveforms of the I2C port are
also at the SYSCLKOUT rate.
The clock enable bit (I2CAENCLK) in the PCLKCRO register turns off the clock to the I2C port for low power
operation. Upon reset, I2CAENCLK is clear, which indicates the peripheral internal clocks are off.
Figure 4-11. I2C Peripheral Module Interfaces
The registers in Table 4-12 configure and control the I2C port operation.
Table 4-12. I2C-A Registers
NAME
ADDRESS
EALLOW
PROTECTED
I2COAR
0x7900
No
I2C own address register
I2CIER
0x7901
No
I2C interrupt enable register
I2CSTR
0x7902
No
I2C status register
I2CCLKL
0x7903
No
I2C clock low-time divider register
I2CCLKH
0x7904
No
I2C clock high-time divider register
I2CCNT
0x7905
No
I2C data count register
I2CDRR
0x7906
No
I2C data receive register
I2CSAR
0x7907
No
I2C slave address register
I2CDXR
0x7908
No
I2C data transmit register
I2CMDR
0x7909
No
I2C mode register
I2CISRC
0x790A
No
I2C interrupt source register
I2CPSC
0x790C
No
I2C prescaler register
I2CFFTX
0x7920
No
I2C FIFO transmit register
I2CFFRX
0x7921
No
I2C FIFO receive register
I2CRSR
–
No
I2C receive shift register (not accessible to the CPU)
I2CXSR
–
No
I2C transmit shift register (not accessible to the CPU)
DESCRIPTION
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
79
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
4.8
www.ti.com
Enhanced PWM Modules (ePWM1/2/3/4/5/6/7)
The devices contain up to seven enhanced PWM Modules (ePWM). Figure 4-12 shows a block diagram of
multiple ePWM modules. Figure 4-13 shows the signal interconnections with the ePWM. See the
TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Enhanced Pulse Width Modulator (ePWM) Module Reference Guide
(literature number SPRUGE9) for more details.
Table 4-13 and Table 4-14 show the complete ePWM register set per module.
80
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
EPWMSYNCI
EPWM1SYNCI
EPWM1B
EPWM1TZINT
EPWM1
Module
EPWM1INT
EPWM2TZINT
PIE
TZ1 to TZ3
EQEP1ERR
TZ4
EPWM2INT
CLOCKFAIL
TZ5
EPWMxTZINT
EMUSTOP
TZ6
EPWMxINT
(A)
EPWM1ENCLK
TBCLKSYNC
eCAPI
EPWM1SYNCO
EPWM1SYNCO
EPWM2SYNCI
COMPOUT1
COMPOUT2
TZ1 to TZ3
EPWM2B
EPWM2
Module
COMP
TZ4
TZ5
TZ6
EQEP1ERR
(A)
EPWM1A
H
R
P
W
M
CLOCKFAIL
EMUSTOP
EPWM2ENCLK
TBCLKSYNC
EPWM2A
EPWMxA
G
P
I
O
ADC
Peripheral Bus
EPWM2SYNCO
SOCA1
SOCB1
SOCA2
SOCB2
EPWMxSYNCI
SOCAx
EPWMx
Module
SOCBx
M
U
X
EPWMxB
TZ1 to TZ3
TZ4
TZ5
TZ6
EQEP1ERR
(A)
EQEP1ERR
CLOCKFAIL
EMUSTOP
eQEP1
EPWMxENCLK
TBCLKSYNC
System Control
C28x CPU
A.
SOCA1
SOCA2
SPCAx
Pulse Stretch
(32 SYSCLKOUT Cycles, Active-Low Output)
ADCSOCAO
SOCB1
SOCB2
SPCBx
Pulse Stretch
(32 SYSCLKOUT Cycles, Active-Low Output)
ADCSOCBO
This signal exists only on devices with an eQEP1 module.
Figure 4-12. ePWM
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
81
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Table 4-13. ePWM1–ePWM4 Control and Status Registers
ePWM1
ePWM2
ePWM3
ePWM4
SIZE (x16) /
#SHADOW
TBCTL
0x6800
0x6840
0x6880
0x68C0
1/0
Time Base Control Register
TBSTS
0x6801
0x6841
0x6881
0x68C1
1/0
Time Base Status Register
TBPHSHR
0x6802
0x6842
0x6882
0x68C2
1/0
Time Base Phase HRPWM Register
TBPHS
0x6803
0x6843
0x6883
0x68C3
1/0
Time Base Phase Register
TBCTR
0x6804
0x6844
0x6884
0x68C4
1/0
Time Base Counter Register
TBPRD
0x6805
0x6845
0x6885
0x68C5
1/1
Time Base Period Register Set
TBPRDHR
0x6806
0x6846
0x6886
0x68C6
1/1
Time Base Period High Resolution Register (1)
CMPCTL
0x6807
0x6847
0x6887
0x68C7
1/0
Counter Compare Control Register
CMPAHR
0x6808
0x6848
0x6888
0x68C8
1/1
Time Base Compare A HRPWM Register
CMPA
0x6809
0x6849
0x6889
0x68C9
1/1
Counter Compare A Register Set
CMPB
0x680A
0x684A
0x688A
0x68CA
1/1
Counter Compare B Register Set
NAME
DESCRIPTION
AQCTLA
0x680B
0x684B
0x688B
0x68CB
1/0
Action Qualifier Control Register For Output A
AQCTLB
0x680C
0x684C
0x688C
0x68CC
1/0
Action Qualifier Control Register For Output B
AQSFRC
0x680D
0x684D
0x688D
0x68CD
1/0
Action Qualifier Software Force Register
AQCSFRC
0x680E
0x684E
0x688E
0x68CE
1/1
Action Qualifier Continuous S/W Force Register Set
DBCTL
0x680F
0x684F
0x688F
0x68CF
1/1
Dead-Band Generator Control Register
DBRED
0x6810
0x6850
0x6890
0x68D0
1/0
Dead-Band Generator Rising Edge Delay Count Register
DBFED
0x6811
0x6851
0x6891
0x68D1
1/0
Dead-Band Generator Falling Edge Delay Count Register
TZSEL
0x6812
0x6852
0x6892
0x68D2
1/0
Trip Zone Select Register (1)
TZDCSEL
0x6813
0x6853
0x6893
0x98D3
1/0
Trip Zone Digital Compare Register
TZCTL
0x6814
0x6854
0x6894
0x68D4
1/0
Trip Zone Control Register (1)
TZEINT
0x6815
0x6855
0x6895
0x68D5
1/0
Trip Zone Enable Interrupt Register (1)
TZFLG
0x6816
0x6856
0x6896
0x68D6
1/0
Trip Zone Flag Register
TZCLR
0x6817
0x6857
0x6897
0x68D7
1/0
Trip Zone Clear Register (1)
TZFRC
0x6818
0x6858
0x6898
0x68D8
1/0
Trip Zone Force Register (1)
(1)
ETSEL
0x6819
0x6859
0x6899
0x68D9
1/0
Event Trigger Selection Register
ETPS
0x681A
0x685A
0x689A
0x68DA
1/0
Event Trigger Prescale Register
ETFLG
0x681B
0x685B
0x689B
0x68DB
1/0
Event Trigger Flag Register
ETCLR
0x681C
0x685C
0x689C
0x68DC
1/0
Event Trigger Clear Register
ETFRC
0x681D
0x685D
0x689D
0x68DD
1/0
Event Trigger Force Register
PCCTL
0x681E
0x685E
0x689E
0x68DE
1/0
PWM Chopper Control Register
HRCNFG
0x6820
0x6860
0x68A0
0x68E0
1/0
HRPWM Configuration Register (1)
(1)
82
Registers that are EALLOW protected.
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 4-13. ePWM1–ePWM4 Control and Status Registers (continued)
ePWM1
ePWM2
ePWM3
ePWM4
SIZE (x16) /
#SHADOW
HRPWR
0x6821
-
-
-
1/0
HRPWM Power Register
HRMSTEP
0x6826
-
-
-
1/0
HRPWM MEP Step Register
HRPCTL
0x6828
0x6868
0x68A8
0x68E8
1/0
High resolution Period Control Register (1)
NAME
(2)
TBPRDHRM
0x682A
0x686A
0x68AA
0x68EA
1/W
TBPRDM
0x682B
0x686B
0x68AB
0x68EB
1 / W (2)
(2)
DESCRIPTION
Time Base Period HRPWM Register Mirror
Time Base Period Register Mirror
CMPAHRM
0x682C
0x686C
0x68AC
0x68EC
1/W
CMPAM
0x682D
0x686D
0x68AD
0x68ED
1 / W (2)
DCTRIPSEL
0x6830
0x6870
0x68B0
0x68F0
1/0
Digital Compare Trip Select Register
DCACTL
0x6831
0x6871
0x68B1
0x68F1
1/0
Digital Compare A Control Register (1)
DCBCTL
0x6832
0x6872
0x68B2
0x68F2
1/0
Digital Compare B Control Register (1)
DCFCTL
0x6833
0x6873
0x68B3
0x68F3
1/0
Digital Compare Filter Control Register (1)
DCCAPCT
0x6834
0x6874
0x68B4
0x68F4
1/0
Digital Compare Capture Control Register (1)
DCFOFFSET
0x6835
0x6875
0x68B5
0x68F5
1/1
Digital Compare Filter Offset Register
DCFOFFSETCNT
0x6836
0x6876
0x68B6
0x68F6
1/0
Digital Compare Filter Offset Counter Register
DCFWINDOW
0x6837
0x6877
0x68B7
0x68F7
1/0
Digital Compare Filter Window Register
DCFWINDOWCNT
0x6838
0x6878
0x68B8
0x68F8
1/0
Digital Compare Filter Window Counter Register
DCCAP
0x6839
0x6879
0x68B9
0x68F9
1/1
Digital Compare Counter Capture Register
(2)
Compare A HRPWM Register Mirror
Compare A Register Mirror
(1)
W = Write to shadow register
Table 4-14. ePWM5–ePWM7 Control and Status Registers
ePWM5
ePWM6
ePWM7
SIZE (x16) /
#SHADOW
TBCTL
0x6900
0x6940
0x6980
1/0
Time Base Control Register
TBSTS
0x6901
0x6941
0x6981
1/0
Time Base Status Register
TBPHSHR
0x6902
0x6942
0x6982
1/0
Time Base Phase HRPWM Register
TBPHS
0x6903
0x6943
0x6983
1/0
Time Base Phase Register
TBCTR
0x6904
0x6944
0x6984
1/0
Time Base Counter Register
TBPRD
0x6905
0x6945
0x6985
1/1
Time Base Period Register Set
TBPRDHR
0x6906
0x6946
0x6986
1/1
Time Base Period High Resolution Register (1)
CMPCTL
0x6907
0x6947
0x6987
1/0
Counter Compare Control Register
CMPAHR
0x6908
0x6948
0x6988
1/1
Time Base Compare A HRPWM Register
CMPA
0x6909
0x6949
0x6989
1/1
Counter Compare A Register Set
NAME
(1)
DESCRIPTION
Registers that are EALLOW protected.
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Peripherals
83
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Table 4-14. ePWM5–ePWM7 Control and Status Registers (continued)
ePWM5
ePWM6
ePWM7
SIZE (x16) /
#SHADOW
CMPB
0x690A
0x694A
0x698A
1/1
Counter Compare B Register Set
AQCTLA
0x690B
0x694B
0x698B
1/0
Action Qualifier Control Register For Output A
AQCTLB
0x690C
0x694C
0x698C
1/0
Action Qualifier Control Register For Output B
AQSFRC
0x690D
0x694D
0x698D
1/0
Action Qualifier Software Force Register
AQCSFRC
0x690E
0x694E
0x698E
1/1
Action Qualifier Continuous S/W Force Register Set
DBCTL
0x690F
0x694F
0x698F
1/1
Dead-Band Generator Control Register
DBRED
0x6910
0x6950
0x6990
1/0
Dead-Band Generator Rising Edge Delay Count Register
DBFED
0x6911
0x6951
0x6991
1/0
Dead-Band Generator Falling Edge Delay Count Register
TZSEL
0x6912
0x6952
0x6992
1/0
Trip Zone Select Register (1)
TZDCSEL
0x6913
0x6953
0x6993
1/0
Trip Zone Digital Compare Register
TZCTL
0x6914
0x6954
0x6994
1/0
Trip Zone Control Register (1)
TZEINT
0x6915
0x6955
0x6995
1/0
Trip Zone Enable Interrupt Register (1)
TZFLG
0x6916
0x6956
0x6996
1/0
Trip Zone Flag Register
TZCLR
0x6917
0x6957
0x6997
1/0
Trip Zone Clear Register (2)
TZFRC
0x6918
0x6958
0x6998
1/0
Trip Zone Force Register (2)
NAME
DESCRIPTION
(1)
ETSEL
0x6919
0x6959
0x6999
1/0
Event Trigger Selection Register
ETPS
0x691A
0x695A
0x699A
1/0
Event Trigger Prescale Register
ETFLG
0x691B
0x695B
0x699B
1/0
Event Trigger Flag Register
ETCLR
0x691C
0x695C
0x699C
1/0
Event Trigger Clear Register
ETFRC
0x691D
0x695D
0x699D
1/0
Event Trigger Force Register
PCCTL
0x691E
0x695E
0x699E
1/0
PWM Chopper Control Register
HRCNFG
0x6920
0x6960
0x69A0
1/0
HRPWM Configuration Register (2)
HRPWR
-
-
-
1/0
HRPWM Power Register
HRMSTEP
-
-
-
1/0
HRPWM MEP Step Register
HRPCTL
0x6928
0x6968
0x69A8
1/0
High resolution Period Control Register (2)
TBPRDHRM
0x692A
0x696A
0x69AA
1 / W (3)
Time Base Period HRPWM Register Mirror
TBPRDM
0x692B
0x696B
0x69AB
1 / W (3)
Time Base Period Register Mirror
CMPAHRM
0x692C
0x696C
0x69AC
1 / W (3)
Compare A HRPWM Register Mirror
CMPAM
0x692D
0x696D
0x69AD
1 / W (3)
Compare A Register Mirror
DCTRIPSEL
0x6930
0x6970
0x69B0
1/0
DCACTL
(2)
(3)
84
0x6931
0x6971
0x69B1
1/0
Digital Compare Trip Select Register
Digital Compare A Control Register
(2)
(2)
Registers that are EALLOW protected.
W = Write to shadow register
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 4-14. ePWM5–ePWM7 Control and Status Registers (continued)
ePWM5
ePWM6
ePWM7
SIZE (x16) /
#SHADOW
DCBCTL
0x6932
0x6972
0x69B2
1/0
Digital Compare B Control Register (2)
DCFCTL
0x6933
0x6973
0x69B3
1/0
Digital Compare Filter Control Register (2)
DCCAPCT
0x6934
0x6974
0x69B4
1/0
Digital Compare Capture Control Register (2)
DCFOFFSET
0x6935
0x6975
0x69B5
1/1
Digital Compare Filter Offset Register
DCFOFFSETCNT
0x6936
0x6976
0x69B6
1/0
Digital Compare Filter Offset Counter Register
DCFWINDOW
0x6937
0x6977
0x69B7
1/0
Digital Compare Filter Window Register
DCFWINDOWCNT
0x6938
0x6978
0x69B8
1/0
Digital Compare Filter Window Counter Register
DCCAP
0x6939
0x6979
0x69B9
1/1
Digital Compare Counter Capture Register
NAME
DESCRIPTION
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Peripherals
85
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Time-Base (TB)
CTR=ZERO
TBPRD Shadow (24)
TBPRD Active (24)
Sync
In/Out
Select
Mux
CTR=CMPB
TBPRDHR (8)
Disabled
EPWMxSYNCO
8
CTR=PRD
TBCTL[SYNCOSEL]
TBCTL[PHSEN]
Counter
Up/Down
(16 Bit)
TBCTL[SWFSYNC]
(Software Forced
Sync)
CTR=ZERO
TCBNT
Active (16)
CTR_Dir
CTR=PRD
CTR=ZERO
CTR=PRD or ZERO
CTR=CMPA
TBPHSHR (8)
16
8
TBPHS Active (24)
Phase
Control
CTR=CMPB
CTR_Dir
DCAEVT1.soc
DCBEVT1.soc
CTR=CMPA
EPWMxSYNCI
DCAEVT1.sync
DCBEVT1.sync
(A)
EPWMxINT
Event
Trigger
and
Interrupt
(ET)
EPWMxSOCA
EPWMxSOCB
EPWMxSOCA
ADC
(A)
EPWMxSOCB
Action
Qualifier
(AQ)
CMPAHR (8)
16
High-resolution PWM (HRPWM)
CMPA Active (24)
CMPA Shadow (24)
Dead
Band
(DB)
CTR=CMPB
16
EPWMxA
EPWMA
PWM
Chopper
(PC)
Trip
Zone
(TZ)
EPWMxB
EPWMB
EPWMxTZINT
CMPB Active (16)
TZ1 to TZ3
CMPB Shadow (16)
CTR=ZERO
DCAEVT1.inter
DCBEVT1.inter
DCAEVT2.inter
DCBEVT2.inter
EMUSTOP
CLOCKFAIL
EQEP1ERR
(B)
DCAEVT1.force
DCAEVT2.force
DCBEVT1.force
DCBEVT2.force
A.
B.
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
These events are generated by the Type 1 ePWM digital compare (DC) submodule based on the levels of
the COMPxOUT and TZ signals.
This signal exists only on devices with an eQEP1 module.
Figure 4-13. ePWM Sub-Modules Showing Critical Internal Signal Interconnections
86
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
4.9
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
High-Resolution PWM (HRPWM)
This module combines multiple delay lines in a single module and a simplified calibration system by using
a dedicated calibration delay line. For each ePWM module there is one HR delay line.
The HRPWM module offers PWM resolution (time granularity) that is significantly better than what can be
achieved using conventionally derived digital PWM methods. The key points for the HRPWM module are:
• Significantly extends the time resolution capabilities of conventionally derived digital PWM
• This capability can be utilized in both single edge (duty cycle and phase-shift control) as well as dual
edge control for frequency/period modulation.
• Finer time granularity control or edge positioning is controlled via extensions to the Compare A and
Phase registers of the ePWM module.
• HRPWM capabilities, when available on a particular device, are offered only on the A signal path of an
ePWM module (that is, on the EPWMxA output). EPWMxB output has conventional PWM capabilities.
NOTE
The minimum SYSCLKOUT frequency allowed for HRPWM is 60 MHz.
NOTE
When dual-edge high-resolution is enabled (high-resolution period mode), the PWMxB output
is not available for use.
For more information on the HRPWM, see the TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo High Resolution Pulse
Width Modulator (HRPWM) Reference Guide (literature number SPRUGE8).
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
87
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
4.10 Enhanced Capture Module (eCAP1)
SYNC
The device contains an enhanced capture (eCAP) module. Figure 4-14 shows a functional block diagram
of a module.
SYNCIn
SYNCOut
CTRPHS
(phase register−32 bit)
TSCTR
(counter−32 bit)
APWM mode
OVF
RST
CTR_OVF
CTR [0−31]
Delta−mode
PWM
compare
logic
PRD [0−31]
CMP [0−31]
32
CTR=PRD
CTR [0−31]
CTR=CMP
32
32
CAP1
(APRD active)
APRD
shadow
32
32
LD
LD1
MODE SELECT
PRD [0−31]
Polarity
select
32
CMP [0−31]
CAP2
(ACMP active)
32
LD
LD2
32
CAP3
(APRD shadow)
LD
32
CAP4
(ACMP shadow)
LD
Polarity
select
Event
qualifier
ACMP
shadow
eCAPx
Event
Pre-scale
Polarity
select
LD3
LD4
Polarity
select
4
Capture events
4
CEVT[1:4]
to PIE
Interrupt
Trigger
and
Flag
control
CTR_OVF
Continuous /
Oneshot
Capture Control
CTR=PRD
CTR=CMP
Figure 4-14. eCAP Functional Block Diagram
The eCAP module is clocked at the SYSCLKOUT rate.
The clock enable bits (ECAP1 ENCLK) in the PCLKCR1 register turn off the eCAP module individually (for
low power operation). Upon reset, ECAP1ENCLK is set to low, indicating that the peripheral clock is off.
88
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 4-15. eCAP Control and Status Registers
NAME
eCAP1
SIZE (x16)
TSCTR
0x6A00
2
EALLOW PROTECTED
Time-Stamp Counter
DESCRIPTION
CTRPHS
0x6A02
2
Counter Phase Offset Value Register
CAP1
0x6A04
2
Capture 1 Register
CAP2
0x6A06
2
Capture 2 Register
CAP3
0x6A08
2
Capture 3 Register
CAP4
0x6A0A
2
Capture 4 Register
Reserved
0x6A0C – 0x6A12
8
Reserved
ECCTL1
0x6A14
1
Capture Control Register 1
ECCTL2
0x6A15
1
Capture Control Register 2
ECEINT
0x6A16
1
Capture Interrupt Enable Register
ECFLG
0x6A17
1
Capture Interrupt Flag Register
ECCLR
0x6A18
1
Capture Interrupt Clear Register
ECFRC
0x6A19
1
Capture Interrupt Force Register
Reserved
0x6A1A – 0x6A1F
6
Reserved
For more information on the eCAP, see the TMS320F2802x, 2803x Piccolo Enhanced Capture (eCAP)
Module Reference Guide (literature number SPRUFZ8).
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
89
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
4.11 High-Resolution Capture (HRCAP) Module
The High-Resolution Capture (HRCAP) module measures the difference between external pulses with a
typical resolution of 300 ps.
Uses for the HRCAP include:
• Capactive touch applications
• High-resolution period and duty cycle measurements of pulse train cycles
• Instantaneous speed measurements
• Instantaneous frequency measurements
• Voltage measurements across an isolation boundary
• Distance/sonar measurement and scanning
The HRCAP module features include:
• Pulse width capture in either non-high-resolution or high-resolution modes
• Difference (Delta) mode pulse width capture
• Typical high-resolution capture on the order of 300 ps resolution on each edge
• Interrupt on either falling or rising edge
• Continuous mode capture of pulse widths in 2-deep buffer
• Calibration logic for precision high-resolution capture
• All of the above resources are dedicated to a single input pin
• HRCAP calibration software library supplied by TI is used for both calibration and calculating fractional
pulse widths
The HRCAP module includes one capture channel in addition to a high-resolution calibration block, which
connects internally to the last available ePWMxA HRPWM channel when calibrating (that is, if there are
eight ePWMs with HRPWM capability, it will be HRPWM8A).
Each HRCAP channel has the following independent key resources:
• Dedicated input capture pin
• 16-bit HRCAP clock which is either equal to the PLL output frequency (asynchronous to SYSCLK) or
equal to the SYSCLK frequency (synchronous to SYSCLK)
• High-resolution pulse width capture in a 2-deep buffer
HRCAP Calibration Logic
EPWMx
HRCAPxENCLK
EPWMxA
HRPWM
SYSCLK
PLLCLK
PIE
HRCAPx
Module
HRCAP Calibration Signal (Internal)
GPIO
Mux
HRCAPxINTn
HRCAPx
Figure 4-15. HRCAP Functional Block Diagram
90
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 4-16. HRCAP Registers
NAME
HRCAP1
HRCAP2
SIZE (x16)
HCCTL
0x6AC0
0x6AE0
1
HRCAP Control Register (1)
DESCRIPTION
HCIFR
0x6AC1
0x6AE1
1
HRCAP Interrupt Flag Register
HCICLR
0x6AC2
0x6AE2
1
HRCAP Interrupt Clear Register
HCIFRC
0x6AC3
0x6AE3
1
HRCAP Interrupt Force Register
HCCOUNTER
0x6AC4
0x6AE4
1
HRCAP 16-bit Counter Register
HCCAPCNTRISE0
0x6AD0
0x6AF0
1
HRCAP Capture Counter on Rising Edge 0 Register
HCCAPCNTFALL0
0x6AD2
0x6AF2
1
HRCAP Capture Counter on Falling Edge 0 Register
HCCAPCNTRISE1
0x6AD8
0x6AF8
1
HRCAP Capture Counter on Rising Edge 1 Register
HCCAPCNTFALL1
0x6ADA
0x6AFA
1
HRCAP Capture Counter on Falling Edge 1 Register
(1)
Registers that are EALLOW-protected.
For more information on the HRCAP, see the TMS320x2803x Piccolo High Resolution Capture (HRCAP)
Reference Guide (literature number SPRUH56).
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
91
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
4.12 Enhanced Quadrature Encoder Pulse (eQEP)
The device contains one enhanced quadrature encoder pulse (eQEP) module.
Table 4-17. eQEP Control and Status Registers
eQEP1
ADDRESS
eQEP1
SIZE(x16)/
#SHADOW
QPOSCNT
0x6B00
2/0
eQEP Position Counter
QPOSINIT
0x6B02
2/0
eQEP Initialization Position Count
QPOSMAX
0x6B04
2/0
eQEP Maximum Position Count
QPOSCMP
0x6B06
2/1
eQEP Position-compare
QPOSILAT
0x6B08
2/0
eQEP Index Position Latch
QPOSSLAT
0x6B0A
2/0
eQEP Strobe Position Latch
QPOSLAT
0x6B0C
2/0
eQEP Position Latch
QUTMR
0x6B0E
2/0
eQEP Unit Timer
QUPRD
0x6B10
2/0
eQEP Unit Period Register
QWDTMR
0x6B12
1/0
eQEP Watchdog Timer
QWDPRD
0x6B13
1/0
eQEP Watchdog Period Register
QDECCTL
0x6B14
1/0
eQEP Decoder Control Register
QEPCTL
0x6B15
1/0
eQEP Control Register
QCAPCTL
0x6B16
1/0
eQEP Capture Control Register
QPOSCTL
0x6B17
1/0
eQEP Position-compare Control Register
QEINT
0x6B18
1/0
eQEP Interrupt Enable Register
QFLG
0x6B19
1/0
eQEP Interrupt Flag Register
QCLR
0x6B1A
1/0
eQEP Interrupt Clear Register
QFRC
0x6B1B
1/0
eQEP Interrupt Force Register
QEPSTS
0x6B1C
1/0
eQEP Status Register
QCTMR
0x6B1D
1/0
eQEP Capture Timer
QCPRD
0x6B1E
1/0
eQEP Capture Period Register
QCTMRLAT
0x6B1F
1/0
eQEP Capture Timer Latch
QCPRDLAT
0x6B20
1/0
eQEP Capture Period Latch
0x6B21 –
0x6B3F
31/0
NAME
Reserved
REGISTER DESCRIPTION
For more information on the eQEP, see the TMS320x2803x Piccolo Enhanced Quadrature Encoder Pulse
(eQEP) Module Reference Guide (literature number SPRUFK8).
92
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Figure 4-16 shows the eQEP functional block diagram.
System Control
Registers
To CPU
EQEPxENCLK
Data Bus
SYSCLKOUT
QCPRD
QCAPCTL
QCTMR
16
16
16
Quadrature
Capture
Unit
(QCAP)
QCTMRLAT
QCPRDLAT
Registers
Used by
Multiple Units
QUTMR
QWDTMR
QUPRD
QWDPRD
32
16
QEPCTL
QEPSTS
UTIME
QFLG
UTOUT
QWDOG
QDECCTL
16
WDTOUT
PIE
QCLK
EQEPxINT
QDIR
16
QI
Position Counter/
Control Unit
(PCCU)
QPOSLAT
QS Quadrature
Decoder
PHE
(QDU)
PCSOUT
QPOSSLAT
QPOSILAT
EQEPxAIN
EQEPxIIN
32
QPOSCNT
QPOSCMP
EQEPxB/XDIR
EQEPxIOUT
EQEPxIOE
EQEPxSIN
EQEPxSOUT
EQEPxSOE
32
EQEPxA/XCLK
EQEPxBIN
GPIO
MUX
EQEPxI
EQEPxS
16
QEINT
QPOSINIT
QFRC
QPOSMAX
QCLR
QPOSCTL
Enhanced QEP (eQEP) Peripheral
Figure 4-16. eQEP Functional Block Diagram
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
93
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
4.13 JTAG Port
On the 2803x device, the JTAG port is reduced to 5 pins (TRST, TCK, TDI, TMS, TDO). TCK, TDI, TMS
and TDO pins are also GPIO pins. The TRST signal selects either JTAG or GPIO operating mode for the
pins in Figure 4-17. During emulation/debug, the GPIO function of these pins are not available. If the
GPIO38/TCK/XCLKIN pin is used to provide an external clock, an alternate clock source should be used
to clock the device during emulation/debug since this pin will be needed for the TCK function.
NOTE
In 2803x devices, the JTAG pins may also be used as GPIO pins. Care should be taken in
the board design to ensure that the circuitry connected to these pins do not affect the
emulation capabilities of the JTAG pin function. Any circuitry connected to these pins should
not prevent the emulator from driving (or being driven by) the JTAG pins for successful
debug.
TRST = 0: JTAG Disabled (GPIO Mode)
TRST = 1: JTAG Mode
TRST
TRST
XCLKIN
GPIO38_in
TCK
TCK/GPIO38
GPIO38_out
C28x
Core
GPIO37_in
TDO/GPIO37
1
0
TDO
GPIO37_out
GPIO36_in
1
TMS
TMS/GPIO36
GPIO36_out
1
0
GPIO35_in
1
TDI
TDI/GPIO35
GPIO35_out
1
0
Figure 4-17. JTAG/GPIO Multiplexing
94
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
4.14 GPIO MUX
The GPIO MUX can multiplex up to three independent peripheral signals on a single GPIO pin in addition
to providing individual pin bit-banging I/O capability.
The device supports 45 GPIO pins. The GPIO control and data registers are mapped to Peripheral
Frame 1 to enable 32-bit operations on the registers (along with 16-bit operations). Table 4-18 shows the
GPIO register mapping.
Table 4-18. GPIO Registers
NAME
ADDRESS
SIZE (x16)
DESCRIPTION
GPACTRL
0x6F80
2
GPIO A Control Register (GPIO0 to 31)
GPAQSEL1
0x6F82
2
GPIO A Qualifier Select 1 Register (GPIO0 to 15)
GPAQSEL2
0x6F84
2
GPIO A Qualifier Select 2 Register (GPIO16 to 31)
GPAMUX1
0x6F86
2
GPIO A MUX 1 Register (GPIO0 to 15)
GPAMUX2
0x6F88
2
GPIO A MUX 2 Register (GPIO16 to 31)
GPADIR
0x6F8A
2
GPIO A Direction Register (GPIO0 to 31)
GPIO CONTROL REGISTERS (EALLOW PROTECTED)
GPAPUD
0x6F8C
2
GPIO A Pull Up Disable Register (GPIO0 to 31)
GPBCTRL
0x6F90
2
GPIO B Control Register (GPIO32 to 44)
GPBQSEL1
0x6F92
2
GPIO B Qualifier Select 1 Register (GPIO32 to 44)
GPBMUX1
0x6F96
2
GPIO B MUX 1 Register (GPIO32 to 44)
GPBDIR
0x6F9A
2
GPIO B Direction Register (GPIO32 to 44)
GPBPUD
0x6F9C
2
GPIO B Pull Up Disable Register (GPIO32 to 44)
AIOMUX1
0x6FB6
2
Analog, I/O mux 1 register (AIO0 to AIO15)
AIODIR
0x6FBA
2
Analog, I/O Direction Register (AIO0 to AIO15)
GPIO DATA REGISTERS (NOT EALLOW PROTECTED)
GPADAT
0x6FC0
2
GPIO A Data Register (GPIO0 to 31)
GPASET
0x6FC2
2
GPIO A Data Set Register (GPIO0 to 31)
GPACLEAR
0x6FC4
2
GPIO A Data Clear Register (GPIO0 to 31)
GPATOGGLE
0x6FC6
2
GPIO A Data Toggle Register (GPIO0 to 31)
GPBDAT
0x6FC8
2
GPIO B Data Register (GPIO32 to 44)
GPBSET
0x6FCA
2
GPIO B Data Set Register (GPIO32 to 44)
GPBCLEAR
0x6FCC
2
GPIO B Data Clear Register (GPIO32 to 44)
GPBTOGGLE
0x6FCE
2
GPIO B Data Toggle Register (GPIO32 to 44)
AIODAT
0x6FD8
2
Analog I/O Data Register (AIO0 to AIO15)
AIOSET
0x6FDA
2
Analog I/O Data Set Register (AIO0 to AIO15)
AIOCLEAR
0x6FDC
2
Analog I/O Data Clear Register (AIO0 to AIO15)
0x6FDE
2
Analog I/O Data Toggle Register (AIO0 to AIO15)
AIOTOGGLE
GPIO INTERRUPT AND LOW POWER MODES SELECT REGISTERS (EALLOW PROTECTED)
GPIOXINT1SEL
0x6FE0
1
XINT1 GPIO Input Select Register (GPIO0 to 31)
GPIOXINT2SEL
0x6FE1
1
XINT2 GPIO Input Select Register (GPIO0 to 31)
GPIOXINT3SEL
0x6FE2
1
XINT3 GPIO Input Select Register (GPIO0 to 31)
GPIOLPMSEL
0x6FE8
2
LPM GPIO Select Register (GPIO0 to 31)
NOTE
There is a two-SYSCLKOUT cycle delay from when the write to the GPxMUXn/AIOMUXn
and GPxQSELn registers occurs to when the action is valid.
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
95
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Table 4-19. GPIOA MUX (1)
DEFAULT AT RESET
PRIMARY I/O
FUNCTION
PERIPHERAL
SELECTION 1
PERIPHERAL
SELECTION 2
PERIPHERAL
SELECTION 3
GPAMUX1 REGISTER
BITS
(GPAMUX1 BITS = 00)
(GPAMUX1 BITS = 01)
(GPAMUX1 BITS = 10)
(GPAMUX1 BITS = 11)
1-0
GPIO0
EPWM1A (O)
Reserved
Reserved
3-2
GPIO1
EPWM1B (O)
Reserved
COMP1OUT (O)
5-4
GPIO2
EPWM2A (O)
Reserved
Reserved
7-6
GPIO3
EPWM2B (O)
SPISOMIA (I/O)
COMP2OUT (O)
9-8
GPIO4
EPWM3A (O)
Reserved
Reserved
11-10
GPIO5
EPWM3B (O)
SPISIMOA (I/O)
ECAP1 (I/O)
13-12
GPIO6
EPWM4A (O)
EPWMSYNCI (I)
EPWMSYNCO (O)
15-14
GPIO7
EPWM4B (O)
SCIRXDA (I)
Reserved
17-16
GPIO8
EPWM5A (O)
Reserved
ADCSOCAO (O)
19-18
GPIO9
EPWM5B (O)
LINTXA (O)
HRCAP1 (I)
21-20
GPIO10
EPWM6A (O)
Reserved
ADCSOCBO (O)
23-22
GPIO11
EPWM6B (O)
LINRXA (I)
HRCAP2 (I)
25-24
GPIO12
TZ1 (I)
SCITXDA (O)
SPISIMOB (I/O)
27-26
GPIO13 (3)
TZ2 (I)
Reserved
SPISOMIB (I/O)
29-28
GPIO14 (3)
TZ3 (I)
LINTXA (O)
SPICLKB (I/O)
31-30
GPIO15 (3)
TZ1 (I)
LINRXA (I)
SPISTEB (I/O)
GPAMUX2 REGISTER
BITS
(GPAMUX2 BITS = 00)
(GPAMUX2 BITS = 01)
(GPAMUX2 BITS = 10)
(GPAMUX2 BITS = 11)
1-0
GPIO16
SPISIMOA (I/O)
Reserved
TZ2 (I)
3-2
GPIO17
SPISOMIA (I/O)
Reserved
TZ3 (I)
5-4
GPIO18
SPICLKA (I/O)
LINTXA (O)
XCLKOUT (O)
7-6
GPIO19/XCLKIN
SPISTEA (I/O)
LINRXA (I)
ECAP1 (I/O)
9-8
GPIO20
EQEP1A (I)
Reserved
COMP1OUT (O)
11-10
GPIO21
EQEP1B (I)
Reserved
COMP2OUT (O)
13-12
GPIO22
EQEP1S (I/O)
Reserved
LINTXA (O)
15-14
GPIO23
EQEP1I (I/O)
Reserved
LINRXA (I)
17-16
GPIO24
ECAP1 (I/O)
Reserved
SPISIMOB (I/O)
19-18
GPIO25 (3)
Reserved
Reserved
SPISOMIB (I/O)
21-20
GPIO26 (3)
HRCAP1 (I)
Reserved
SPICLKB (I/O)
23-22
(3)
(1)
(2)
(3)
96
(2)
HRCAP2 (I)
Reserved
SPISTEB (I/O)
25-24
GPIO27
GPIO28
SCIRXDA (I)
SDAA (I/OD)
TZ2 (I)
27-26
GPIO29
SCITXDA (O)
SCLA (I/OD)
TZ3 (I)
29-28
GPIO30
CANRXA (I)
Reserved
Reserved
31-30
GPIO31
CANTXA (O)
Reserved
Reserved
The word reserved means that there is no peripheral assigned to this GPxMUX1/2 register setting. Should it be selected, the state of the
pin will be undefined and the pin may be driven. This selection is a reserved configuration for future expansion.
I = Input, O = Output, OD = Open Drain
These pins are not available in the 64-pin package.
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 4-20. GPIOB MUX (1)
DEFAULT AT RESET
PRIMARY I/O FUNCTION
PERIPHERAL
SELECTION 1
PERIPHERAL
SELECTION 2
PERIPHERAL
SELECTION 3
GPBMUX1 REGISTER
BITS
(GPBMUX1 BITS = 00)
(GPBMUX1 BITS = 01)
(GPBMUX1 BITS = 10)
(GPBMUX1 BITS = 11)
1-0
GPIO32
SDAA (I/OD)
EPWMSYNCI (I)
ADCSOCAO (O)
3-2
GPIO33
SCLA (I/OD)
EPWMSYNCO (O)
ADCSOCBO (O)
5-4
GPIO34
COMP2OUT (O)
Reserved
COMP3OUT (O)
7-6
GPIO35 (TDI)
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
9-8
GPIO36 (TMS)
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
11-10
GPIO37 (TDO)
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
13-12
GPIO38/XCLKIN (TCK)
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
(1)
(2)
(2)
15-14
GPIO39
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
17-16
GPIO40 (2)
EPWM7A (O)
Reserved
Reserved
19-18
GPIO41 (2)
EPWM7B (O)
Reserved
Reserved
21-20
GPIO42
(2)
Reserved
Reserved
COMP1OUT (O)
23-22
GPIO43 (2)
Reserved
Reserved
COMP2OUT (O)
25-24
GPIO44 (2)
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
27-26
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
29-28
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
31-30
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
I = Input, O = Output, OD = Open Drain
These pins are not available in the 64-pin package.
Table 4-21. Analog MUX (1)
DEFAULT AT RESET
AIOx AND PERIPHERAL SELECTION 1
PERIPHERAL SELECTION 2 AND
PERIPHERAL SELECTION 3
AIOMUX1 REGISTER BITS
AIOMUX1 BITS = 0,x
AIOMUX1 BITS = 1,x
1-0
ADCINA0 (I)
ADCINA0 (I)
3-2
ADCINA1 (I)
ADCINA1 (I)
5-4
AIO2 (I/O)
ADCINA2 (I), COMP1A (I)
7-6
ADCINA3 (I)
ADCINA3 (I)
9-8
AIO4 (I/O)
ADCINA4 (I), COMP2A (I)
11-10
(2)
(I)
ADCINA5 (I)
13-12
AIO6 (I/O)
ADCINA6 (I), COMP3A (I)
15-14
ADCINA7 (I)
ADCINA7 (I)
17-16
ADCINB0 (I)
ADCINB0 (I)
19-18
ADCINB1 (I)
ADCINB1 (I)
21-20
AIO10 (I/O)
ADCINB2 (I), COMP1B (I)
23-22
ADCINB3 (I)
ADCINB3 (I)
AIO12 (I/O)
ADCINB4 (I), COMP2B (I)
25-24
27-26
(1)
(2)
ADCINA5
ADCINB5
(2)
(I)
ADCINB5 (I)
29-28
AIO14 (I/O)
ADCINB6 (I), COMP3B (I)
31-30
ADCINB7 (I)
ADCINB7 (I)
I = Input, O = Output
These pins are not available in the 64-pin package.
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
97
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
The user can select the type of input qualification for each GPIO pin via the GPxQSEL1/2 registers from
four choices:
• Synchronization To SYSCLKOUT Only (GPxQSEL1/2 = 0, 0): This is the default mode of all GPIO pins
at reset and it simply synchronizes the input signal to the system clock (SYSCLKOUT).
• Qualification Using Sampling Window (GPxQSEL1/2 = 0, 1 and 1, 0): In this mode the input signal,
after synchronization to the system clock (SYSCLKOUT), is qualified by a specified number of cycles
before the input is allowed to change.
• The sampling period is specified by the QUALPRD bits in the GPxCTRL register and is configurable in
groups of 8 signals. It specifies a multiple of SYSCLKOUT cycles for sampling the input signal. The
sampling window is either 3-samples or 6-samples wide and the output is only changed when ALL
samples are the same (all 0s or all 1s) as shown in Figure 4-18 (for 6 sample mode).
• No Synchronization (GPxQSEL1/2 = 1,1): This mode is used for peripherals where synchronization is
not required (synchronization is performed within the peripheral).
Due to the multi-level multiplexing that is required on the device, there may be cases where a peripheral
input signal can be mapped to more then one GPIO pin. Also, when an input signal is not selected, the
input signal will default to either a 0 or 1 state, depending on the peripheral.
98
Peripherals
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
GPIOXINT1SEL
GPIOLMPSEL
GPIOXINT2SEL
LPMCR0
GPIOXINT3SEL
External Interrupt
MUX
Low P ower
Modes Block
Asynchronous
path
PIE
GPxDAT (read)
GPxQSEL1/2
GPxCTRL
GPxPUD
Input
Qualification
Internal
Pullup
00
N/C
01
Peripheral 1 Input
10
Peripheral 2 Input
11
Peripheral 3 Input
GPxTOGGLE
Asynchronous path
GPIOx pin
GPxCLEAR
GPxSET
00
01
GPxDAT (latch)
Peripheral 1 Output
10
Peripheral 2 Output
11
Peripheral 3 Output
High Impedance
Output Control
00
0 = Input, 1 = Output
XRS
= Default at Reset
A.
B.
C.
GPxDIR (latch)
01
Peripheral 1 Output Enable
10
Peripheral 2 Output Enable
11
Peripheral 3 Output Enable
GPxMUX1/2
x stands for the port, either A or B. For example, GPxDIR refers to either the GPADIR and GPBDIR register
depending on the particular GPIO pin selected.
GPxDAT latch/read are accessed at the same memory location.
This is a generic GPIO MUX block diagram. Not all options may be applicable for all GPIO pins. See the
TMS320x2803x Piccolo System Control and Interrupts Reference Guide (literature number SPRUGL8) for pin-specific
variations.
Figure 4-18. GPIO Multiplexing
Peripherals
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
99
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
5 Device Support
Texas Instruments (TI) offers an extensive line of development tools for the C28x™ generation of MCUs,
including tools to evaluate the performance of the processors, generate code, develop algorithm
implementations, and fully integrate and debug software and hardware modules.
The following products support development of 2803x-based applications:
Software Development Tools
• Code Composer Studio™ Integrated Development Environment (IDE)
– C/C++ Compiler
– Code generation tools
– Assembler/Linker
– Cycle Accurate Simulator
• Application algorithms
• Sample applications code
Hardware Development Tools
• Development and evaluation boards
• JTAG-based emulators - XDS510™ class, XDS560™ emulator, XDS100
• Flash programming tools
• Power supply
• Documentation and cables
5.1
Device and Development Support Tool Nomenclature
To designate the stages in the product development cycle, TI assigns prefixes to the part numbers of all
TMS320™ MCU devices and support tools. Each TMS320™ MCU commercial family member has one of
three prefixes: TMX, TMP, or TMS (for example, TMS320F28032). Texas Instruments recommends two of
three possible prefix designators for its support tools: TMDX and TMDS. These prefixes represent
evolutionary stages of product development from engineering prototypes (TMX/TMDX) through fully
qualified production devices/tools (TMS/TMDS).
Device development evolutionary flow:
TMX
Experimental device that is not necessarily representative of the final device's electrical
specifications
TMP
Final silicon die that conforms to the device's electrical specifications but has not
completed quality and reliability verification
TMS
Fully qualified production device
Support tool development evolutionary flow:
TMDX Development-support product that has not yet completed Texas Instruments internal
qualification testing
TMDS Fully qualified development-support product
TMX and TMP devices and TMDX development-support tools are shipped against the following
disclaimer:
"Developmental product is intended for internal evaluation purposes."
TMS devices and TMDS development-support tools have been characterized fully, and the quality and
reliability of the device have been demonstrated fully. TI's standard warranty applies.
100
Device Support
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Predictions show that prototype devices (TMX or TMP) have a greater failure rate than the standard
production devices. Texas Instruments recommends that these devices not be used in any production
system because their expected end-use failure rate still is undefined. Only qualified production devices are
to be used.
TI device nomenclature also includes a suffix with the device family name. This suffix indicates the
package type (for example, PN) and temperature range (for example, T). Figure 5-1 provides a legend for
reading the complete device name for any family member.
TMS 320
F 28032
PN
T
PREFIX
TMX = experimental device
TMP = prototype device
TMS = qualified device
TEMPERATURE RANGE
T = −40°C to 105°C
S = −40°C to 125°C
Q = −40°C to 125°C
(Q refers to Q100 qualification for automotive applications.)
DEVICE FAMILY
320 = TMS320 MCU Family
PACKAGE TYPE
56-Pin RSH Very Small Quad Flatpack (No Lead) (VQFN)
64-Pin PAG Thin Quad Flatpack (TQFP)
80-Pin PN Low-Profile Quad Flatpack (LQFP)
DEVICE
28035
28034
28033
28032
28031
28030
TECHNOLOGY
F = Flash
Figure 5-1. Device Nomenclature
Device Support
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
101
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
5.2
www.ti.com
Related Documentation
Extensive documentation supports all of the TMS320™ MCU family generations of devices from product
announcement through applications development. The types of documentation available include: data
sheets and data manuals, with design specifications; and hardware and software applications.
Table 5-1 shows the peripheral reference guides appropriate for use with the devices in this data manual.
See the TMS320x28xx, 28xxx DSP Peripheral Reference Guide (literature number SPRU566) for more
information on types of peripherals.
Table 5-1. TMS320F2803x Peripheral Selection Guide
PERIPHERAL
LIT. NO.
TYPE (1)
28030, 28031,
28032, 28033,
28034, 28035
TMS320x2803x Piccolo System Control and Interrupts
SPRUGL8
–
X
TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) and Comparator
SPRUGE5
3/0 (2)
X
TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Serial Communications Interface (SCI)
SPRUGH1
0
X
TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
SPRUG71
1
X
TMS320x2803x Piccolo Boot ROM
SPRUGO0
–
X
TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Enhanced Pulse Width Modulator (ePWM) Module
SPRUGE9
1
X
TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Enhanced Capture (eCAP) Module
SPRUFZ8
0
X
TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C)
SPRUFZ9
0
X
TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo High-Resolution Pulse-Width Modulator (HRPWM)
SPRUGE8
1
X
TMS320x2803x Piccolo Control Law Accelerator (CLA)
SPRUGE6
0
X
TMS320x2803x Piccolo Local Interconnect Network (LIN) Module
SPRUGE2
0
X
TMS320x2803x Piccolo Enhanced Quadrature Encoder Pulse (eQEP)
SPRUFK8
0
X
TMS320x2803x Piccolo Enhanced Controller Area Network (eCAN)
SPRUGL7
0
X
TMS320x2803x Piccolo High-Resolution Capture (HRCAP)
SPRUH56
0
X
(1)
(2)
A type change represents a major functional feature difference in a peripheral module. Within a peripheral type, there may be minor
differences between devices that do not affect the basic functionality of the module. These device-specific differences are listed in the
peripheral reference guides.
The ADC module is Type 3 and the comparator module is Type 0.
The following documents can be downloaded from the TI website (www.ti.com):
Data Manual
SPRS584
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032, TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034,
TMS320F28035 Piccolo Microcontrollers Data Manual contains the pinout, signal
descriptions, as well as electrical and timing specifications for the 2803x devices.
SPRZ295
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032, TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034,
TMS320F28035 Piccolo MCU Silicon Errata describes known advisories on silicon and
provides workarounds.
CPU User's Guides
SPRU430
TMS320C28x CPU and Instruction Set Reference Guide describes the central processing
unit (CPU) and the assembly language instructions of the TMS320C28x fixed-point digital
signal processors (DSPs). It also describes emulation features available on these DSPs.
Peripheral Guides
SPRUGL8 TMS320x2803x Piccolo System Control and Interrupts Reference Guide describes the
various interrupts and system control features of the 2803x microcontrollers (MCUs).
SPRU566
102
Device Support
TMS320x28xx, 28xxx DSP Peripheral Reference Guide describes the peripheral reference
guides of the 28x digital signal processors (DSPs).
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
SPRUGO0
TMS320x2803x Piccolo Boot ROM Reference Guide describes the purpose and features
of the boot loader (factory-programmed boot-loading software) and provides examples of
code. It also describes other contents of the device on-chip boot ROM and identifies where
all of the information is located within that memory.
SPRUGE5
TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) and Comparator
Reference Guide describes how to configure and use the on-chip ADC module, which is a
12-bit pipelined ADC.
SPRUGE9
TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Enhanced Pulse Width Modulator (ePWM) Module
Reference Guide describes the main areas of the enhanced pulse width modulator that
include digital motor control, switch mode power supply control, UPS (uninterruptible power
supplies), and other forms of power conversion.
SPRUGE8
TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo High-Resolution Pulse Width Modulator (HRPWM)
describes the operation of the high-resolution extension to the pulse width modulator
(HRPWM).
SPRUGH1
TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Serial Communications Interface (SCI) Reference Guide
describes how to use the SCI.
SPRUFZ8
TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Enhanced Capture (eCAP) Module Reference Guide
describes the enhanced capture module. It includes the module description and registers.
SPRUG71
TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Reference Guide
describes the SPI - a high-speed synchronous serial input/output (I/O) port - that allows a
serial bit stream of programmed length (one to sixteen bits) to be shifted into and out of the
device at a programmed bit-transfer rate.
SPRUFZ9
TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Reference Guide describes
the features and operation of the inter-integrated circuit (I2C) module.
SPRUGE6
TMS320x2803x Piccolo Control Law Accelerator (CLA) Reference Guide describes the
operation of the Control Law Accelerator (CLA).
SPRUGE2
TMS320x2803x Piccolo Local Interconnect Network (LIN) Module Reference Guide
describes the operation of the Local Interconnect Network (LIN) Module.
SPRUFK8
TMS320x2803x Piccolo Enhanced Quadrature Encoder Pulse (eQEP) Reference Guide
describes the operation of the Enhanced Quadrature Encoder Pulse (eQEP) .
SPRUGL7
TMS320x2803x Piccolo Enhanced Controller Area Network (eCAN) Reference Guide
describes the operation of the Enhanced Controller Area Network (eCAN).
SPRUH56
TMS320x2803x Piccolo High-Resolution Capture (HRCAP) User's Guide describes the
operation of the High-Resolution Capture (HRCAP) module.
Tools Guides
SPRU513
TMS320C28x Assembly Language Tools v5.0.0 User's Guide describes the assembly
language tools (assembler and other tools used to develop assembly language code),
assembler directives, macros, common object file format, and symbolic debugging directives
for the TMS320C28x device.
SPRU514
TMS320C28x Optimizing C/C++ Compiler v5.0.0 User's Guide describes the
TMS320C28x™ C/C++ compiler. This compiler accepts ANSI standard C/C++ source code
and produces TMS320 DSP assembly language source code for the TMS320C28x device.
SPRU608
TMS320C28x Instruction Set Simulator Technical Overview describes the simulator,
available within the Code Composer Studio for TMS320C2000 IDE, that simulates the
instruction set of the C28x™ core.
Device Support
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
103
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
5.3
www.ti.com
Community Resources
The following links connect to TI community resources. Linked contents are provided "AS IS" by the
respective contributors. They do not constitute TI specifications and do not necessarily reflect TI's views;
see TI's Terms of Use.
TI E2E Community TI's Engineer-to-Engineer (E2E) Community. Created to foster collaboration
among engineers. At e2e.ti.com, you can ask questions, share knowledge, explore ideas and
help solve problems with fellow engineers.
TI Embedded Processors Wiki Texas Instruments Embedded Processors Wiki. Established to help
developers get started with Embedded Processors from Texas Instruments and to foster
innovation and growth of general knowledge about the hardware and software surrounding
these devices.
104
Device Support
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
6 Electrical Specifications
6.1
Absolute Maximum Ratings (1)
(2)
Supply voltage range, VDDIO (I/O and Flash)
with respect to VSS
–0.3 V to 4.6 V
Supply voltage range, VDD
with respect to VSS
–0.3 V to 2.5 V
Analog voltage range, VDDA
with respect to VSSA
–0.3 V to 4.6 V
Input voltage range, VIN (3.3 V)
–0.3 V to 4.6 V
Output voltage range, VO
–0.3 V to 4.6 V
Input clamp current, IIK (VIN < 0 or VIN > VDDIO) (3)
±20 mA
Output clamp current, IOK (VO < 0 or VO > VDDIO)
±20 mA
Junction temperature range, TJ
(4)
Storage temperature range, Tstg
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
6.2
–40°C to 150°C
(4)
–65°C to 150°C
Stresses beyond those listed under Absolute Maximum Ratings may cause permanent damage to the device. These are stress ratings
only, and functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions beyond those indicated under Section 6.2 is not implied.
Exposure to absolute-maximum-rated conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability.
All voltage values are with respect to VSS, unless otherwise noted.
Continuous clamp current per pin is ± 2 mA.
Long-term high-temperature storage and/or extended use at maximum temperature conditions may result in a reduction of overall device
life. For additional information, see IC Package Thermal Metrics Application Report (literature number SPRA953) and Reliability Data for
TMS320LF24xx and TMS320F28xx Devices Application Report (literature number SPRA963).
Recommended Operating Conditions
Device supply voltage, I/O, VDDIO
(1)
Device supply voltage CPU, VDD (When internal
VREG is disabled and 1.8 V is supplied externally)
MIN
NOM
2.97
1.71
2.97
3.3
Supply ground, VSS
Analog ground, VSSA
Junction temperature, TJ
(1)
(2)
V
1.995
V
V
3.63
V
V
60
2
VDDIO + 0.3
VSS – 0.3
0.8
V
All GPIO/AIO pins
–4
mA
Group 2 (2)
Low-level input voltage, VIL (3.3 V)
Ambient temperature, TA
3.63
1.8
2
High-level input voltage, VIH (3.3 V)
Junction temperature, TJ
3.3
0
Device clock frequency (system clock)
Low-level output sink current, VOL = VOL(MAX), IOL
UNIT
0
Analog supply voltage, VDDA (1)
High-level output source current, VOH = VOH(MIN) , IOH
MAX
MHz
V
–8
mA
All GPIO/AIO pins
4
mA
Group 2 (2)
8
mA
T version
–40
105
S version
–40
125
Q version (Q100 qualification)
–40
125
–40
150
°C
°C
VDDIO and VDDA should be maintained within ~0.3 V of each other.
Group 2 pins are as follows: GPIO16, GPIO17, GPIO18, GPIO19, GPIO28, GPIO29, GPIO36, GPIO37
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
105
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
6.3
www.ti.com
Electrical Characteristics (1)
over recommended operating conditions (unless otherwise noted)
PARAMETER
VOH
High-level output voltage
VOL
Low-level output voltage
IIL
IIH
Input current
(low level)
Input current
(high level)
TEST CONDITIONS
MIN
IOH = IOH MAX
2.4
IOH = 50 μA
V
VDDIO – 0.2
IOL = IOL MAX
0.4
All GPIO
–80
–140
–205
XRS pin
–230
–300
–375
VDDIO = 3.3 V, VIN = 0 V
Pin with pulldown
enabled
VDDIO = 3.3 V, VIN = 0 V
±2
Pin with pullup
enabled
VDDIO = 3.3 V, VIN = VDDIO
±2
Pin with pulldown
enabled
VDDIO = 3.3 V, VIN = VDDIO
Output current, pullup or
pulldown disabled
CI
Input capacitance
VDDIO BOR trip point
V
μA
μA
28
50
VO = VDDIO or 0 V
80
±2
2
Falling VDDIO
2.50
VDDIO BOR hysteresis
106
MAX UNIT
Pin with pullup
enabled
IOZ
(1)
TYP
2.78
pF
2.96
35
Supervisor reset release delay
time
Time after BOR/POR/OVR event is removed to XRS
release
VREG VDD output
Internal VREG on
400
μA
V
mV
800
μs
1.9
V
When the on-chip VREG is used, its output is monitored by the POR/BOR circuit, which will reset the device should the core voltage
(VDD) go out of range.
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
6.4
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Current Consumption
Table 6-1. TMS320F2803x Current Consumption at 60-MHz SYSCLKOUT
VREG ENABLED
MODE
IDDIO (1)
TEST CONDITIONS
TYP
Operational
(Flash)
The following peripheral clocks
are enabled:
•
ePWM1/2/3/4/5/6/7
•
eCAP1
•
eQEP1
•
eCAN
•
LIN
•
CLA
•
HRPWM
•
SCI-A
•
SPI-A/B
•
ADC
(3)
VREG DISABLED
IDDA (2)
MAX
TYP
(3)
MAX
IDDIO (1)
IDD
TYP
(3)
MAX
TYP
(3)
MAX
IDDA (2)
TYP
(3)
MAX
114 mA (6)
135 mA (6)
14 mA
18 mA
101 mA (6)
120 mA (6)
14 mA
18 mA
14 mA
18 mA
•
I2C
•
COMP1/2/3
•
CPU-TIMER0/1/2
All PWM pins are toggled at
60 kHz.
All I/O pins are left
unconnected. (4) (5)
Code is running out of flash
with 2 wait-states.
XCLKOUT is turned off.
IDLE
Flash is powered down.
XCLKOUT is turned off.
All peripheral clocks are turned
off.
13 mA
23 mA
10 μA
15 μA
13 mA
24 mA
120 μA
400 μA
10 μA
15 μA
STANDBY
Flash is powered down.
Peripheral clocks are off.
4 mA
9 mA
10 μA
15 μA
4 mA
7 mA
120 μA
400 μA
10 μA
15 μA
HALT
Flash is powered down.
Peripheral clocks are off.
Input clock is disabled. (7)
46 μA
10 μA
15 μA
30 μA
10 μA
15 μA
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
24 μA
IDDIO current is dependent on the electrical loading on the I/O pins.
In order to realize the IDDA currents shown for IDLE, STANDBY, and HALT, clock to the ADC module must be turned off explicitly by
writing to the PCLKCR0 register.
The TYP numbers are applicable over room temperature and nominal voltage.
The following is done in a loop:
• Data is continuously transmitted out of SPI-A/B, SCI-A, eCAN, LIN, and I2C ports.
• The hardware multiplier is exercised.
• Watchdog is reset.
• ADC is performing continuous conversion.
• COMP1/2 are continuously switching voltages.
• GPIO17 is toggled.
CLA is continuously performing polynomial calculations.
For F2803x devices that do not have CLA, subtract the IDD current number for CLA (see Table 6-2) from the IDD (VREG disabled)/IDDIO
(VREG enabled) current numbers shown in Table 6-1 for operational mode.
If a quartz crystal or ceramic resonator is used as the clock source, the HALT mode shuts down the on-chip crystal oscillator.
NOTE
The peripheral - I/O multiplexing implemented in the device prevents all available peripherals
from being used at the same time. This is because more than one peripheral function may
share an I/O pin. It is, however, possible to turn on the clocks to all the peripherals at the
same time, although such a configuration is not useful. If this is done, the current drawn by
the device will be more than the numbers specified in the current consumption tables.
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
107
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
6.4.1
www.ti.com
Reducing Current Consumption
The 2803x devices incorporate a method to reduce the device current consumption. Since each peripheral
unit has an individual clock-enable bit, significant reduction in current consumption can be achieved by
turning off the clock to any peripheral module that is not used in a given application. Furthermore, any one
of the three low-power modes could be taken advantage of to reduce the current consumption even
further. Table 6-2 indicates the typical reduction in current consumption achieved by turning off the clocks.
Table 6-2. Typical Current Consumption by Various
Peripherals (at 60 MHz) (1)
(1)
(2)
(3)
PERIPHERAL
MODULE (2)
IDD CURRENT
REDUCTION (mA)
ADC
2 (3)
2
I C
3
ePWM
2
eCAP
2
eQEP
2
SCI
2
SPI
2
COMP/DAC
1
HRPWM
3
HRCAP
3
CPU-TIMER
1
Internal zero-pin oscillator
0.5
CAN
2.5
LIN
1.5
CLA
20
All peripheral clocks (except CPU Timer clock) are disabled upon
reset. Writing to/reading from peripheral registers is possible only
after the peripheral clocks are turned on.
For peripherals with multiple instances, the current quoted is per
module. For example, the 2 mA value quoted for ePWM is for one
ePWM module.
This number represents the current drawn by the digital portion of
the ADC module. Turning off the clock to the ADC module results in
the elimination of the current drawn by the analog portion of the ADC
(IDDA) as well.
NOTE
IDDIO current consumption is reduced by 15 mA (typical) when XCLKOUT is turned off.
NOTE
The baseline IDD current (current when the core is executing a dummy loop with no
peripherals enabled) is 40 mA, typical. To arrive at the IDD current for a given application, the
current-drawn by the peripherals (enabled by that application) must be added to the baseline
IDD current.
Following are other methods to reduce power consumption further:
• The flash module may be powered down if code is run off SARAM. This results in a current reduction
of 18 mA (typical) in the VDD rail and 13 mA (typical) in the VDDIO rail.
• Savings in IDDIO may be realized by disabling the pullups on pins that assume an output function.
108
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
6.4.2
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Current Consumption Graphs (VREG Enabled)
Operational Current vs Frequency
140
Operational Current (mA)
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
60
70
SYSCLKOUT (MHz)
IDDIO
IDDA
Figure 6-1. Typical Operational Current Versus Frequency (F2803x)
Operational Power vs Frequency
Operational Power (mW)
500
450
400
350
300
250
200
0
10
20
30
40
50
SYSCLKOUT (MHz)
Figure 6-2. Typical Operational Power Versus Frequency (F2803x)
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
109
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Typical CLA operational current vs SYSCLKOUT
CLA operational IDDIO current (mA)
25
20
15
10
5
0
10
15
20
25
30
35
40
45
50
55
60
SYSCLKOUT (MHz)
Figure 6-3. Typical CLA Operational Current Versus SYSCLKOUT
110
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
6.5
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Thermal Design Considerations
Based on the end application design and operational profile, the IDD and IDDIO currents could vary.
Systems that exceed the recommended maximum power dissipation in the end product may require
additional thermal enhancements. Ambient temperature (TA) varies with the end application and product
design. The critical factor that affects reliability and functionality is TJ, the junction temperature, not the
ambient temperature. Hence, care should be taken to keep TJ within the specified limits. Tcase should be
measured to estimate the operating junction temperature TJ. Tcase is normally measured at the center of
the package top-side surface. The thermal application reports IC Package Thermal Metrics (literature
number SPRA953) and Reliability Data for TMS320LF24xx and TMS320F28xx Devices (literature number
SPRA963) help to understand the thermal metrics and definitions.
6.6
Emulator Connection Without Signal Buffering for the MCU
Figure 6-4 shows the connection between the MCU and JTAG header for a single-processor configuration.
If the distance between the JTAG header and the MCU is greater than 6 inches, the emulation signals
must be buffered. If the distance is less than 6 inches, buffering is typically not needed. Figure 6-4 shows
the simpler, no-buffering situation. For the pullup/pulldown resistor values, see Section 2.2, Signal
Descriptions.
6 inches or less
VDDIO
VDDIO
13
14
2
TRST
1
TMS
3
TDI
TDO
TCK
7
11
9
EMU0
PD
EMU1
TRST
GND
TMS
GND
TDI
GND
TDO
GND
TCK
GND
5
4
6
8
10
12
TCK_RET
MCU
JTAG Header
A.
See Figure 4-17 for JTAG/GPIO multiplexing.
Figure 6-4. Emulator Connection Without Signal Buffering for the MCU
NOTE
The 2803x devices do not have EMU0/EMU1 pins. For designs that have a JTAG Header
on-board, the EMU0/EMU1 pins on the header must be tied to VDDIO through a 4.7-kΩ
(typical) resistor.
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
111
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
6.7
www.ti.com
Timing Parameter Symbology
Timing parameter symbols used are created in accordance with JEDEC Standard 100. To shorten the
symbols, some of the pin names and other related terminology have been abbreviated as follows:
6.7.1
Lowercase subscripts and their
meanings:
Letters and symbols and their
meanings:
a
access time
H
High
c
cycle time (period)
L
Low
d
delay time
V
Valid
f
fall time
X
Unknown, changing, or don't care
level
h
hold time
Z
High impedance
r
rise time
su
setup time
t
transition time
v
valid time
w
pulse duration (width)
General Notes on Timing Parameters
All output signals from the 28x devices (including XCLKOUT) are derived from an internal clock such that
all output transitions for a given half-cycle occur with a minimum of skewing relative to each other.
The signal combinations shown in the following timing diagrams may not necessarily represent actual
cycles. For actual cycle examples, see the appropriate cycle description section of this document.
6.7.2
Test Load Circuit
This test load circuit is used to measure all switching characteristics provided in this document.
Tester Pin Electronics
42 W
Data Sheet Timing Reference Point
3.5 nH
Output
Under
Test
Transmission Line
(A)
Z0 = 50 W
4.0 pF
A.
B.
Device Pin
1.85 pF
(B)
Input requirements in this data sheet are tested with an input slew rate of < 4 Volts per nanosecond (4 V/ns) at the
device pin.
The data sheet provides timing at the device pin. For output timing analysis, the tester pin electronics and its
transmission line effects must be taken into account. A transmission line with a delay of 2 ns or longer can be used to
produce the desired transmission line effect. The transmission line is intended as a load only. It is not necessary to
add or subtract the transmission line delay (2 ns or longer) from the data sheet timing.
Figure 6-5. 3.3-V Test Load Circuit
112
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
6.7.3
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Device Clock Table
This section provides the timing requirements and switching characteristics for the various clock options
available on the 2803x MCUs. Table 6-3 lists the cycle times of various clocks.
Table 6-3. 2803x Clock Table and Nomenclature (60-MHz Devices)
MIN
tc(SCO), Cycle time
SYSCLKOUT
Frequency
tc(LCO), Cycle time
LSPCLK (1)
tc(ADCCLK), Cycle time
(1)
(2)
MAX
UNIT
500
ns
2
60
MHz
60
MHz
16.67
66.67 (2)
15 (2)
Frequency
ADC clock
NOM
16.67
ns
16.67
ns
Frequency
60
MHz
MAX
UNIT
Lower LSPCLK will reduce device power consumption.
This is the default reset value if SYSCLKOUT = 60 MHz.
Table 6-4. Device Clocking Requirements/Characteristics
MIN
On-chip oscillator (X1/X2 pins)
(Crystal/Resonator)
tc(OSC), Cycle time
External oscillator/clock source
(XCLKIN pin) — PLL Enabled
tc(CI), Cycle time (C8)
External oscillator/clock source
(XCLKIN pin) — PLL Disabled
tc(CI), Cycle time (C8)
Limp mode SYSCLKOUT
(with /2 enabled)
XCLKOUT
PLL lock time (1)
(1)
Frequency
Frequency
Frequency
50
200
ns
5
20
MHz
33.3
200
ns
MHz
5
30
33.33
250
ns
4
30
MHz
Frequency range
tc(XCO), Cycle time (C1)
Frequency
tp
NOM
1 to 5
MHz
66.67
2000
0.5
15
MHz
ns
1
ms
The PLLLOCKPRD register must be updated based on the number of OSCCLK cycles. If the zero-pin internal oscillators (10 MHz) are
used as the clock source, then the PLLLOCKPRD register must be written with a value of 10,000 (minimum).
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
113
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Table 6-5. Internal Zero-Pin Oscillator (INTOSC1/INTOSC2) Characteristics
PARAMETER
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNIT
Internal zero-pin oscillator 1 (INTOSC1) at 30°C (1) (2)
Frequency
10.000
MHz
Internal zero-pin oscillator 2 (INTOSC2) at 30°C (1) (2)
Frequency
10.000
MHz
55
kHz
Step size (coarse trim)
Step size (fine trim)
14
Temperature drift (3)
3.03
4.85 kHz/°C
Voltage (VDD) drift (3)
175
Hz/mV
(1)
(2)
(3)
kHz
In order to achieve better oscillator accuracy (10 MHz ± 1% or better) than shown, refer to the oscillator calibration example in
2803x C/C++ Header Files and Peripheral Examples (literature number SPRC892), and the Oscillator Compensation Guide Application
Report (literature number SPRAB84). Refer to Figure 6-6 for TYP/MAX values.
Frequency range ensured only when VREG is enabled, VREGENZ = VSS.
Output frequency of the internal oscillators follows the direction of both the temperature gradient and voltage (VDD) gradient. For
example:
• Increase in temperature will cause the output frequency to increase per the temperature coefficient.
• Decrease in voltage (VDD) will cause the output frequency to decrease per the voltage coefficient.
Zero-Pin Oscillator Frequency Movement With Temperature
10.6
10.5
Output Frequency (MHz)
10.4
10.3
10.2
10.1
10
9.9
9.8
9.7
9.6
–40
–30
–20
–10
Typical
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
100
110
120
Temperature (°C)
Max
Figure 6-6. Zero-Pin Oscillator Frequency Movement With Temperature
114
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
6.8
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Clock Requirements and Characteristics
Table 6-6. XCLKIN Timing Requirements - PLL Enabled
NO.
MIN
MAX
UNIT
C9
tf(CI)
Fall time, XCLKIN
6
ns
C10
tr(CI)
Rise time, XCLKIN
6
ns
C11
tw(CIL)
Pulse duration, XCLKIN low as a percentage of tc(OSCCLK)
45
55
%
C12
tw(CIH)
Pulse duration, XCLKIN high as a percentage of tc(OSCCLK)
45
55
%
MIN
MAX
Table 6-7. XCLKIN Timing Requirements - PLL Disabled
NO.
C9
tf(CI)
Fall time, XCLKIN
C10
tr(CI)
Rise time, XCLKIN
Up to 20 MHz
6
20 MHz to 30 MHz
2
Up to 20 MHz
6
20 MHz to 30 MHz
2
UNIT
ns
ns
C11
tw(CIL)
Pulse duration, XCLKIN low as a percentage of tc(OSCCLK)
45
55
%
C12
tw(CIH)
Pulse duration, XCLKIN high as a percentage of tc(OSCCLK)
45
55
%
The possible configuration modes are shown in Table 3-20.
Table 6-8. XCLKOUT Switching Characteristics (PLL Bypassed or Enabled) (1)
(2)
over recommended operating conditions (unless otherwise noted)
NO.
(1)
(2)
PARAMETER
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNIT
C3
tf(XCO)
Fall time, XCLKOUT
5
ns
C4
tr(XCO)
Rise time, XCLKOUT
5
ns
C5
tw(XCOL)
Pulse duration, XCLKOUT low
H–2
H+2
ns
C6
tw(XCOH)
Pulse duration, XCLKOUT high
H–2
H+2
ns
A load of 40 pF is assumed for these parameters.
H = 0.5tc(XCO)
C10
C9
C8
XCLKIN(A)
C1
C6
C3
C4
C5
XCLKOUT(B)
A.
B.
The relationship of XCLKIN to XCLKOUT depends on the divide factor chosen. The waveform relationship shown is
intended to illustrate the timing parameters only and may differ based on actual configuration.
XCLKOUT configured to reflect SYSCLKOUT.
Figure 6-7. Clock Timing
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
115
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
6.9
www.ti.com
Power Sequencing
There is no power sequencing requirement needed to ensure the device is in the proper state after reset
or to prevent the I/Os from glitching during power up/down (GPIO19, GPIO34–38 do not have glitch-free
I/Os). No voltage larger than a diode drop (0.7 V) above VDDIO should be applied to any digital pin (for
analog pins, it is 0.7 V above VDDA) prior to powering up the device. Voltages applied to pins on an
unpowered device can bias internal p-n junctions in unintended ways and produce unpredictable results.
VDDIO, VDDA
(3.3 V)
VDD (1.8 V)
INTOSC1
tINTOSCST
X1/X2
tOSCST
(B)
(A)
XCLKOUT
User-code dependent
tw(RSL1)
XRS
(D)
Address/data valid, internal boot-ROM code execution phase
Address/Data/
Control
(Internal)
td(EX)
th(boot-mode)(C)
Boot-Mode
Pins
User-code execution phase
User-code dependent
GPIO pins as input
Peripheral/GPIO function
Based on boot code
Boot-ROM execution starts
(E)
GPIO pins as input (state depends on internal PU/PD)
I/O Pins
User-code dependent
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Upon power up, SYSCLKOUT is OSCCLK/4. Since the XCLKOUTDIV bits in the XCLK register come up with a reset
state of 0, SYSCLKOUT is further divided by 4 before it appears at XCLKOUT. XCLKOUT = OSCCLK/16 during this
phase.
Boot ROM configures the DIVSEL bits for /1 operation. XCLKOUT = OSCCLK/4 during this phase. Note that
XCLKOUT will not be visible at the pin until explicitly configured by user code.
After reset, the boot ROM code samples Boot Mode pins. Based on the status of the Boot Mode pin, the boot code
branches to destination memory or boot code function. If boot ROM code executes after power-on conditions (in
debugger environment), the boot code execution time is based on the current SYSCLKOUT speed. The SYSCLKOUT
will be based on user environment and could be with or without PLL enabled.
Using the XRS pin is optional due to the on-chip power-on reset (POR) circuitry.
The internal pullup/pulldown will take effect when BOR is driven high.
Figure 6-8. Power-on Reset
116
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 6-9. Reset (XRS) Timing Requirements
MIN
th(boot-mode)
Hold time for boot-mode pins
tw(RSL2)
Pulse duration, XRS low on warm reset
NOM
MAX
UNIT
1000tc(SCO)
cycles
32tc(OSCCLK)
cycles
Table 6-10. Reset (XRS) Switching Characteristics
over recommended operating conditions (unless otherwise noted)
PARAMETER
TEST CONDITIONS
tw(RSL1)
Pulse duration, XRS driven by device
tw(WDRS)
Pulse duration, reset pulse generated by
watchdog
td(EX)
Delay time, address/data valid after XRS high
tINTOSCST
Start up time, internal zero-pin oscillator
tOSCST
(1)
(1)
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNIT
μs
600
On-chip crystal-oscillator start-up time
512tc(OSCCLK)
cycles
32tc(OSCCLK)
cycles
1
3
μs
10
ms
Dependent on crystal/resonator and board design.
INTOSC1
X1/X2
XCLKOUT
User-Code Dependent
tw(RSL2)
XRS
Address/Data/
Control
(Internal)
td(EX)
User-Code Execution
Boot-ROM Execution Starts
Boot-Mode
Pins
User-Code Execution Phase
Peripheral/GPIO Function
GPIO Pins as Input
th(boot-mode)(A)
Peripheral/GPIO Function
User-Code Execution Starts
I/O Pins
User-Code Dependent
GPIO Pins as Input (State Depends on Internal PU/PD)
User-Code Dependent
A.
After reset, the Boot ROM code samples BOOT Mode pins. Based on the status of the Boot Mode pin, the boot code
branches to destination memory or boot code function. If Boot ROM code executes after power-on conditions (in
debugger environment), the Boot code execution time is based on the current SYSCLKOUT speed. The
SYSCLKOUT will be based on user environment and could be with or without PLL enabled.
Figure 6-9. Warm Reset
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
117
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Figure 6-10 shows an example for the effect of writing into PLLCR register. In the first phase, PLLCR =
0x0004 and SYSCLKOUT = OSCCLK x 2. The PLLCR is then written with 0x0008. Right after the PLLCR
register is written, the PLL lock-up phase begins. During this phase, SYSCLKOUT = OSCCLK/2. After the
PLL lock-up is complete, SYSCLKOUT reflects the new operating frequency, OSCCLK x 4.
OSCCLK
Write to PLLCR
SYSCLKOUT
OSCCLK * 2
OSCCLK * 4
OSCCLK/2
(CPU frequency while PLL is stabilizing
with the desired frequency. This period
(PLL lock-up time tp) is 1 ms long.)
(Current CPU
Frequency)
(Changed CPU frequency)
Figure 6-10. Example of Effect of Writing Into PLLCR Register
6.10 General-Purpose Input/Output (GPIO)
6.10.1
GPIO - Output Timing
Table 6-11. General-Purpose Output Switching Characteristics
over recommended operating conditions (unless otherwise noted)
PARAMETER
MIN
MAX
(1)
tr(GPO)
Rise time, GPIO switching low to high
All GPIOs
13
tf(GPO)
Fall time, GPIO switching high to low
All GPIOs
13 (1)
tfGPO
Toggling frequency
(1)
15
UNIT
ns
ns
MHz
Rise time and fall time vary with electrical loading on I/O pins. Values given in Table 6-11 are applicable for a 40-pF load on I/O pins.
GPIO
tr(GPO)
tf(GPO)
Figure 6-11. General-Purpose Output Timing
118
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
6.10.2
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
GPIO - Input Timing
Table 6-12. General-Purpose Input Timing Requirements
MIN
tw(SP)
Sampling period
tw(IQSW)
Input qualifier sampling window
tw(GPI)
(1)
(2)
(2)
UNIT
QUALPRD = 0
1tc(SCO)
cycles
QUALPRD ≠ 0
2tc(SCO) * QUALPRD
cycles
tw(SP) * (n (1) – 1)
cycles
2tc(SCO)
cycles
tw(IQSW) + tw(SP) + 1tc(SCO)
cycles
Synchronous mode
Pulse duration, GPIO low/high
MAX
With input qualifier
"n" represents the number of qualification samples as defined by GPxQSELn register.
For tw(GPI), pulse width is measured from VIL to VIL for an active low signal and VIH to VIH for an active high signal.
(A)
GPIO Signal
GPxQSELn = 1,0 (6 samples)
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
tw(SP)
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
Sampling Window
1
1
1
Sampling Period determined
by GPxCTRL[QUALPRD]
tw(IQSW)
1
[(SYSCLKOUT cycle * 2 * QUALPRD) * 5
(B)
(C)
]
SYSCLKOUT
QUALPRD = 1
(SYSCLKOUT/2)
(D)
Output From
Qualifier
A.
B.
C.
D.
This glitch will be ignored by the input qualifier. The QUALPRD bit field specifies the qualification sampling period. It
can vary from 00 to 0xFF. If QUALPRD = 00, then the sampling period is 1 SYSCLKOUT cycle. For any other value
"n", the qualification sampling period in 2n SYSCLKOUT cycles (that is, at every 2n SYSCLKOUT cycles, the GPIO
pin will be sampled).
The qualification period selected via the GPxCTRL register applies to groups of 8 GPIO pins.
The qualification block can take either three or six samples. The GPxQSELn Register selects which sample mode is
used.
In the example shown, for the qualifier to detect the change, the input should be stable for 10 SYSCLKOUT cycles or
greater. In other words, the inputs should be stable for (5 x QUALPRD x 2) SYSCLKOUT cycles. This would ensure
5 sampling periods for detection to occur. Since external signals are driven asynchronously, an 13-SYSCLKOUT-wide
pulse ensures reliable recognition.
Figure 6-12. Sampling Mode
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
119
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
6.10.3 Sampling Window Width for Input Signals
The following section summarizes the sampling window width for input signals for various input qualifier
configurations.
Sampling frequency denotes how often a signal is sampled with respect to SYSCLKOUT.
Sampling frequency = SYSCLKOUT/(2 * QUALPRD), if QUALPRD ≠ 0
Sampling frequency = SYSCLKOUT, if QUALPRD = 0
Sampling period = SYSCLKOUT cycle x 2 x QUALPRD, if QUALPRD ≠ 0
In the above equations, SYSCLKOUT cycle indicates the time period of SYSCLKOUT.
Sampling period = SYSCLKOUT cycle, if QUALPRD = 0
In a given sampling window, either 3 or 6 samples of the input signal are taken to determine the validity of
the signal. This is determined by the value written to GPxQSELn register.
Case 1:
Qualification using 3 samples
Sampling window width = (SYSCLKOUT cycle x 2 x QUALPRD) x 2, if QUALPRD ≠ 0
Sampling window width = (SYSCLKOUT cycle) x 2, if QUALPRD = 0
Case 2:
Qualification using 6 samples
Sampling window width = (SYSCLKOUT cycle x 2 x QUALPRD) x 5, if QUALPRD ≠ 0
Sampling window width = (SYSCLKOUT cycle) x 5, if QUALPRD = 0
SYSCLK
GPIOxn
tw(GPI)
Figure 6-13. General-Purpose Input Timing
VDDIO
> 1 MS
2 pF
VSS
VSS
Figure 6-14. Input Resistance Model for a GPIO Pin With an Internal Pull-up
120
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
6.10.4 Low-Power Mode Wakeup Timing
Table 6-13 shows the timing requirements, Table 6-14 shows the switching characteristics, and Figure 615 shows the timing diagram for IDLE mode.
Table 6-13. IDLE Mode Timing Requirements (1)
MIN
tw(WAKE-INT)
(1)
Pulse duration, external wake-up signal
Without input qualifier
NOM
MAX
2tc(SCO)
With input qualifier
UNIT
cycles
5tc(SCO) + tw(IQSW)
For an explanation of the input qualifier parameters, see Table 6-12.
Table 6-14. IDLE Mode Switching Characteristics (1)
over recommended operating conditions (unless otherwise noted)
PARAMETER
TEST CONDITIONS
Delay time, external wake signal to program execution resume
•
td(WAKE-IDLE)
•
•
MIN
Wake-up from Flash
– Flash module in active state
Without input qualifier
Wake-up from Flash
– Flash module in sleep state
Without input qualifier
Wake-up from SARAM
Without input qualifier
With input qualifier
With input qualifier
With input qualifier
(1)
(2)
TYP
MAX
(2)
UNIT
cycles
20tc(SCO)
cycles
20tc(SCO) + tw(IQSW)
1050tc(SCO)
cycles
1050tc(SCO) + tw(IQSW)
20tc(SCO)
cycles
20tc(SCO) + tw(IQSW)
For an explanation of the input qualifier parameters, see Table 6-12.
This is the time taken to begin execution of the instruction that immediately follows the IDLE instruction. execution of an ISR (triggered
by the wake-up) signal involves additional latency.
td(WAKE−IDLE)
Address/Data
(internal)
XCLKOUT
tw(WAKE−INT)
WAKE INT
A.
B.
(A)(B)
WAKE INT can be any enabled interrupt, WDINT or XRS. After the IDLE instruction is executed, a delay of 5
OSCCLK cycles (minimum) is needed before the wake-up signal could be asserted.
From the time the IDLE instruction is executed to place the device into low-power mode (LPM), wakeup should not be
initiated until at least 4 OSCCLK cycles have elapsed.
Figure 6-15. IDLE Entry and Exit Timing
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
121
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Table 6-15. STANDBY Mode Timing Requirements
tw(WAKE-INT)
(1)
Pulse duration, external
wake-up signal
TEST CONDITIONS
MIN
Without input qualification
3tc(OSCCLK)
With input qualification (1)
NOM
MAX
UNIT
cycles
(2 + QUALSTDBY) * tc(OSCCLK)
QUALSTDBY is a 6-bit field in the LPMCR0 register.
Table 6-16. STANDBY Mode Switching Characteristics
over recommended operating conditions (unless otherwise noted)
PARAMETER
td(IDLE-XCOL)
TEST CONDITIONS
Delay time, IDLE instruction
executed to XCLKOUT low
MIN
32tc(SCO)
TYP
MAX
UNIT
45tc(SCO)
cycles
Delay time, external wake signal to program execution
resume (1)
•
td(WAKE-STBY)
•
Wake up from flash
– Flash module in active
state
Without input qualifier
Wake up from flash
– Flash module in sleep
state
Without input qualifier
With input qualifier
With input qualifier
Without input qualifier
•
(1)
122
Wake up from SARAM
With input qualifier
cycles
100tc(SCO)
100tc(SCO) + tw(WAKE-INT)
cycles
1125tc(SCO)
1125tc(SCO) + tw(WAKE-INT)
100tc(SCO)
100tc(SCO) + tw(WAKE-INT)
cycles
cycles
This is the time taken to begin execution of the instruction that immediately follows the IDLE instruction. execution of an ISR (triggered
by the wake up signal) involves additional latency.
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
(C)
(A)
(B)
Device
Status
(F)
(D)(E)
STANDBY
(G)
STANDBY
Normal Execution
Flushing Pipeline
Wake-up
(H)
Signal
tw(WAKE-INT)
td(WAKE-STBY)
X1/X2 or
XCLKIN
XCLKOUT
td(IDLE−XCOL)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
G.
H.
IDLE instruction is executed to put the device into STANDBY mode.
The PLL block responds to the STANDBY signal. SYSCLKOUT is held for the number of cycles indicated below
before being turned off:
•
16 cycles, when DIVSEL = 00 or 01
•
32 cycles, when DIVSEL = 10
•
64 cycles, when DIVSEL = 11
This delay enables the CPU pipeline and any other pending operations to flush properly.
Clock to the peripherals are turned off. However, the PLL and watchdog are not shut down. The device is now in
STANDBY mode. After the IDLE instruction is executed, a delay of 5 OSCCLK cycles (minimum) is needed before the
wake-up signal could be asserted.
The external wake-up signal is driven active.
The wake-up signal fed to a GPIO pin to wake up the device must meet the minimum pulse width requirement.
Furthermore, this signal must be free of glitches. If a noisy signal is fed to a GPIO pin, the wake-up behavior of the
device will not be deterministic and the device may not exit low-power mode for subsequent wake-up pulses.
After a latency period, the STANDBY mode is exited.
Normal execution resumes. The device will respond to the interrupt (if enabled).
From the time the IDLE instruction is executed to place the device into low-power mode (LPM), wakeup should not be
initiated until at least 4 OSCCLK cycles have elapsed.
Figure 6-16. STANDBY Entry and Exit Timing Diagram
Table 6-17. HALT Mode Timing Requirements
MIN
NOM
MAX
UNIT
tw(WAKE-GPIO)
Pulse duration, GPIO wake-up signal
toscst + 2tc(OSCCLK)
cycles
tw(WAKE-XRS)
Pulse duration, XRS wakeup signal
toscst + 8tc(OSCCLK)
cycles
Table 6-18. HALT Mode Switching Characteristics
over recommended operating conditions (unless otherwise noted)
PARAMETER
td(IDLE-XCOL)
Delay time, IDLE instruction executed to XCLKOUT low
tp
PLL lock-up time
td(WAKE-HALT)
Delay time, PLL lock to program execution resume
•
Wake up from flash
– Flash module in sleep state
•
Wake up from SARAM
MIN
32tc(SCO)
TYP
MAX
UNIT
45tc(SCO)
cycles
1
ms
1125tc(SCO)
cycles
35tc(SCO)
cycles
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
123
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
(C)
(A)
(F)
(B)
Device
Status
HALT
Flushing Pipeline
(H)
(G)
(D)(E)
HALT
PLL Lock-up Time
Wake-up Latency
Normal
Execution
(I)
GPIOn
td(WAKE−HALT )
tw(WAKE-GPIO)
tp
X1/X2 or
XCLKIN
Oscillator Start-up Time
XCLKOUT
td(IDLE−XCOL)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
G.
H.
I.
IDLE instruction is executed to put the device into HALT mode.
The PLL block responds to the HALT signal. SYSCLKOUT is held for the number of cycles indicated below before
oscillator is turned off and the CLKIN to the core is stopped:
•
16 cycles, when DIVSEL = 00 or 01
•
32 cycles, when DIVSEL = 10
•
64 cycles, when DIVSEL = 11
This delay enables the CPU pipeline and any other pending operations to flush properly.
Clocks to the peripherals are turned off and the PLL is shut down. If a quartz crystal or ceramic resonator is used as
the clock source, the internal oscillator is shut down as well. The device is now in HALT mode and consumes
absolute minimum power. It is possible to keep the zero-pin internal oscillators (INTOSC1 and INTOSC2) and the
watchdog alive in HALT mode. This is done by writing to the appropriate bits in the CLKCTL register. After the IDLE
instruction is executed, a delay of 5 OSCCLK cycles (minimum) is needed before the wake-up signal could be
asserted.
When the GPIOn pin (used to bring the device out of HALT) is driven low, the oscillator is turned on and the oscillator
wake-up sequence is initiated. The GPIO pin should be driven high only after the oscillator has stabilized. This
enables the provision of a clean clock signal during the PLL lock sequence. Since the falling edge of the GPIO pin
asynchronously begins the wakeup procedure, care should be taken to maintain a low noise environment prior to
entering and during HALT mode.
The wake-up signal fed to a GPIO pin to wake up the device must meet the minimum pulse width requirement.
Furthermore, this signal must be free of glitches. If a noisy signal is fed to a GPIO pin, the wake-up behavior of the
device will not be deterministic and the device may not exit low-power mode for subsequent wake-up pulses.
Once the oscillator has stabilized, the PLL lock sequence is initiated, which takes 1 ms.
When CLKIN to the core is enabled, the device will respond to the interrupt (if enabled), after a latency. The HALT
mode is now exited.
Normal operation resumes.
From the time the IDLE instruction is executed to place the device into low-power mode (LPM), wakeup should not be
initiated until at least 4 OSCCLK cycles have elapsed.
Figure 6-17. HALT Wake-Up Using GPIOn
124
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
6.11 Enhanced Control Peripherals
6.11.1 Enhanced Pulse Width Modulator (ePWM) Timing
PWM refers to PWM outputs on ePWM1–7. Table 6-19 shows the PWM timing requirements and Table 620, switching characteristics.
Table 6-19. ePWM Timing Requirements (1)
TEST CONDITIONS
tw(SYCIN)
Sync input pulse width
MIN
Asynchronous
(1)
UNIT
cycles
2tc(SCO)
cycles
1tc(SCO) + tw(IQSW)
cycles
Synchronous
With input qualifier
MAX
2tc(SCO)
For an explanation of the input qualifier parameters, see Table 6-12.
Table 6-20. ePWM Switching Characteristics
over recommended operating conditions (unless otherwise noted)
PARAMETER
tw(PWM)
Pulse duration, PWMx output high/low
tw(SYNCOUT)
Sync output pulse width
td(PWM)tza
Delay time, trip input active to PWM forced high
Delay time, trip input active to PWM forced low
td(TZ-PWM)HZ
Delay time, trip input active to PWM Hi-Z
TEST CONDITIONS
MIN
MAX
UNIT
33.33
ns
8tc(SCO)
cycles
no pin load
25
ns
20
ns
6.11.2 Trip-Zone Input Timing
Table 6-21. Trip-Zone Input Timing Requirements (1)
MIN
tw(TZ)
Pulse duration, TZx input low
Asynchronous
(1)
UNIT
cycles
2tc(TBCLK)
cycles
2tc(TBCLK) + tw(IQSW)
cycles
Synchronous
With input qualifier
MAX
2tc(TBCLK)
For an explanation of the input qualifier parameters, see Table 6-12.
SYSCLK
tw(TZ)
(A)
TZ
td(TZ-PWM)HZ
(B)
PWM
A.
B.
TZ - TZ1, TZ2, TZ3 , TZ4, TZ5, TZ6
PWM refers to all the PWM pins in the device. The state of the PWM pins after TZ is taken high depends on the PWM
recovery software.
Figure 6-18. PWM Hi-Z Characteristics
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
125
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
6.11.3 High-Resolution PWM (HRPWM) Timing
Table 6-22 shows the high-resolution PWM switching characteristics.
Table 6-22. High-Resolution PWM Characteristics (1)
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNIT
150
310
ps
Micro Edge Positioning (MEP) step size (2)
(1)
(2)
The HRPWM operates at a minimum SYSCLKOUT frequency of 60 MHz.
Maximum MEP step size is based on worst-case process, maximum temperature and minimum voltage. MEP step size will increase
with low voltage and high temperature and decrease with voltage and cold temperature.
Applications that use the HRPWM feature should use MEP Scale Factor Optimizer (SFO) estimation software functions. See the TI
software libraries for details of using SFO function in end applications. SFO functions help to estimate the number of MEP steps per
SYSCLKOUT period dynamically while the HRPWM is in operation.
6.11.4 Enhanced Capture (eCAP) Timing
Table 6-23 shows the eCAP timing requirement and Table 6-24 shows the eCAP switching characteristics.
Table 6-23. Enhanced Capture (eCAP) Timing Requirement (1)
TEST CONDITIONS
tw(CAP)
Capture input pulse width
MIN
UNIT
2tc(SCO)
cycles
Synchronous
2tc(SCO)
cycles
1tc(SCO) + tw(IQSW)
cycles
With input qualifier
(1)
MAX
Asynchronous
For an explanation of the input qualifier parameters, see Table 6-12.
Table 6-24. eCAP Switching Characteristics
over recommended operating conditions (unless otherwise noted)
PARAMETER
tw(APWM)
TEST CONDITIONS
MIN
Pulse duration, APWMx output high/low
MAX
20
UNIT
ns
6.11.5 High-Resolution Capture (HRCAP) Timing
Table 6-25. High-Resolution Capture (HRCAP) Timing Requirements
MIN
tc(HCCAPCLK)
Cycle time, HRCAP capture clock
tw(HRCAP)
Pulse width, HRCAP capture
HRCAP step size
(1)
(2)
126
(2)
NOM
8.333
MAX
10.204
7tc(HCCAPCLK) (1)
UNIT
ns
ns
300
ps
The listed minimum pulse width does not take into account the limitation that all relevant HCCAP registers must be read and RISE/FALL
event flags cleared within the pulse width to ensure valid capture data.
HRCAP step size will increase with low voltage and high temperature and decrease with high voltage and low temperature. Applications
that use the HRCAP in high-resolution mode should use the HRCAP calibration functions to dynamically calibrate for varying operating
conditions.
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
6.11.6 Enhanced Quadrature Encoder Pulse (eQEP) Timing
Table 6-26 shows the eQEP timing requirement and Table 6-27 shows the eQEP switching
characteristics.
Table 6-26. Enhanced Quadrature Encoder Pulse (eQEP) Timing Requirements (1)
TEST CONDITIONS
MIN
Asynchronous (2)/synchronous
tw(QEPP)
QEP input period
tw(INDEXH)
QEP Index Input High time
With input qualifier
QEP Index Input Low time
2[1tc(SCO) + tw(IQSW)]
cycles
2tc(SCO)
cycles
2tc(SCO) +tw(IQSW)
cycles
Asynchronous (2)/synchronous
(2)
Asynchronous /synchronous
With input qualifier
tw(STROBH)
QEP Strobe High time
tw(STROBL)
QEP Strobe Input Low time
2tc(SCO)
cycles
2tc(SCO) + tw(IQSW)
cycles
2tc(SCO)
cycles
2tc(SCO) + tw(IQSW)
cycles
2tc(SCO)
cycles
2tc(SCO) +tw(IQSW)
cycles
Asynchronous (2)/synchronous
With input qualifier
Asynchronous (2)/synchronous
With input qualifier
(1)
(2)
UNIT
cycles
With input qualifier
tw(INDEXL)
MAX
2tc(SCO)
For an explanation of the input qualifier parameters, see Table 6-12.
Refer to the TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032, TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035 Piccolo MCU
Silicon Errata (literature number SPRZ295) for limitations in the asynchronous mode.
Table 6-27. eQEP Switching Characteristics
over recommended operating conditions (unless otherwise noted)
MAX
UNIT
td(CNTR)xin
Delay time, external clock to counter increment
PARAMETER
TEST CONDITIONS
MIN
4tc(SCO)
cycles
td(PCS-OUT)QEP
Delay time, QEP input edge to position compare sync
output
6tc(SCO)
cycles
6.11.7 ADC Start-of-Conversion Timing
Table 6-28. External ADC Start-of-Conversion Switching Characteristics
over recommended operating conditions (unless otherwise noted)
PARAMETER
tw(ADCSOCL)
MIN
Pulse duration, ADCSOCxO low
32tc(HCO )
MAX
UNIT
cycles
tw(ADCSOCL)
ADCSOCAO
or
ADCSOCBO
Figure 6-19. ADCSOCAO or ADCSOCBO Timing
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
127
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
6.11.8 External Interrupt Timing
Table 6-29. External Interrupt Timing Requirements (1)
TEST CONDITIONS
tw(INT)
(1)
(2)
(2)
Pulse duration, INT input low/high
MIN
MAX
UNIT
Synchronous
1tc(SCO)
cycles
With qualifier
1tc(SCO) + tw(IQSW)
cycles
For an explanation of the input qualifier parameters, see Table 6-12.
This timing is applicable to any GPIO pin configured for ADCSOC functionality.
Table 6-30. External Interrupt Switching Characteristics (1)
over recommended operating conditions (unless otherwise noted)
PARAMETER
td(INT)
(1)
MIN
Delay time, INT low/high to interrupt-vector fetch
MAX
UNIT
tw(IQSW) + 12tc(SCO)
cycles
For an explanation of the input qualifier parameters, see Table 6-12.
tw(INT)
XINT1, XINT2, XINT3
td(INT)
Address bus
(internal)
Interrupt Vector
Figure 6-20. External Interrupt Timing
128
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
6.11.9 I2C Electrical Specification and Timing
Table 6-31. I2C Timing
TEST CONDITIONS
MIN
2
I C clock module frequency is between
7 MHz and 12 MHz and I2C prescaler and
clock divider registers are configured
appropriately
MAX
UNIT
400
kHz
fSCL
SCL clock frequency
vil
Low level input voltage
Vih
High level input voltage
Vhys
Input hysteresis
Vol
Low level output voltage
3 mA sink current
tLOW
Low period of SCL clock
I2C clock module frequency is between
7 MHz and 12 MHz and I2C prescaler and
clock divider registers are configured
appropriately
1.3
μs
tHIGH
High period of SCL clock
I2C clock module frequency is between
7 MHz and 12 MHz and I2C prescaler and
clock divider registers are configured
appropriately
0.6
μs
lI
Input current with an input voltage
between 0.1 VDDIO and 0.9 VDDIO MAX
0.3 VDDIO
V
0.7 VDDIO
V
0.05 VDDIO
V
0
–10
0.4
10
V
μA
6.11.10 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Master Mode Timing
Table 6-32 lists the master mode timing (clock phase = 0) and Table 6-33 lists the timing (clock
phase = 1). Figure 6-21 and Figure 6-22 show the timing waveforms.
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
129
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Table 6-32. SPI Master Mode External Timing (Clock Phase = 0) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5)
SPI WHEN (SPIBRR + 1) IS EVEN OR
SPIBRR = 0 OR 2
NO.
MIN
SPI WHEN (SPIBRR + 1) IS ODD
AND SPIBRR > 3
MAX
MIN
UNIT
MAX
1
tc(SPC)M
Cycle time, SPICLK
4tc(LCO)
128tc(LCO)
5tc(LCO)
127tc(LCO)
ns
2
tw(SPCH)M
Pulse duration, SPICLK high
(clock polarity = 0)
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M
0.5tc(SPC)M – 0.5tc(LCO) – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M – 0.5tc(LCO)
ns
tw(SPCL)M
Pulse duration, SPICLK low
(clock polarity = 1)
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M
0.5tc(SPC)M – 0.5tc(LCO) – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M – 0.5tc(LCO)
tw(SPCL)M
Pulse duration, SPICLK low
(clock polarity = 0)
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M
0.5tc(SPC)M + 0.5tc(LCO) – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M + 0.5tc(LCO)
tw(SPCH)M
Pulse duration, SPICLK high
(clock polarity = 1)
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M
0.5tc(SPC)M + 0.5tc(LCO) – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M + 0.5tc(LCO)
td(SPCH-SIMO)M
Delay time, SPICLK high to SPISIMO
valid (clock polarity = 0)
10
10
td(SPCL-SIMO)M
Delay time, SPICLK low to SPISIMO
valid (clock polarity = 1)
10
10
tv(SPCL-SIMO)M
Valid time, SPISIMO data valid after
SPICLK low (clock polarity = 0)
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M + 0.5tc(LCO) – 10
tv(SPCH-SIMO)M
Valid time, SPISIMO data valid after
SPICLK high (clock polarity = 1)
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M + 0.5tc(LCO) – 10
tsu(SOMI-SPCL)M
Setup time, SPISOMI before SPICLK
low (clock polarity = 0)
26
26
tsu(SOMI-SPCH)M
Setup time, SPISOMI before SPICLK
high (clock polarity = 1)
26
26
tv(SPCL-SOMI)M
Valid time, SPISOMI data valid after
SPICLK low (clock polarity = 0)
0.25tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M – 0.5tc(LCO) – 10
tv(SPCH-SOMI)M
Valid time, SPISOMI data valid after
SPICLK high (clock polarity = 1)
0.25tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M – 0.5tc(LCO) – 10
3
4
5
8
9
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
130
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
The MASTER / SLAVE bit (SPICTL.2) is set and the CLOCK PHASE bit (SPICTL.3) is cleared.
tc(SPC) = SPI clock cycle time = LSPCLK/4 or LSPCLK/(SPIBRR +1)
tc(LCO) = LSPCLK cycle time
Internal clock prescalers must be adjusted such that the SPI clock speed is limited to the following SPI clock rate:
Master mode transmit 15-MHz MAX, master mode receive 10-MHz MAX
Slave mode transmit 10-MHz MAX, slave mode receive 10-MHz MAX.
The active edge of the SPICLK signal referenced is controlled by the clock polarity bit (SPICCR.6).
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
1
SPICLK
(clock polarity = 0)
2
3
SPICLK
(clock polarity = 1)
4
5
SPISIMO
Master Out Data Is Valid
8
9
SPISOMI
Master In Data
Must Be Valid
(A)
SPISTE
A.
In the master mode, SPISTE goes active 0.5tc(SPC) (minimum) before valid SPI clock edge. On the trailing end of the word, the SPISTE will go inactive 0.5tc(SPC) after
the receiving edge (SPICLK) of the last data bit, except that SPISTE stays active between back-to-back transmit words in both FIFO and non-FIFO modes.
Figure 6-21. SPI Master Mode External Timing (Clock Phase = 0)
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Electrical Specifications
131
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Table 6-33. SPI Master Mode External Timing (Clock Phase = 1) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5)
SPI WHEN (SPIBRR + 1) IS EVEN
OR SPIBRR = 0 OR 2
NO.
MIN
MAX
SPI WHEN (SPIBRR + 1) IS ODD
AND SPIBRR > 3
MIN
UNIT
MAX
1
tc(SPC)M
Cycle time, SPICLK
4tc(LCO)
128tc(LCO)
5tc(LCO)
127tc(LCO)
ns
2
tw(SPCH)M
Pulse duration, SPICLK high
(clock polarity = 0)
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M
0.5tc(SPC)M – 0.5tc (LCO) – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M – 0.5tc(LCO)
ns
tw(SPCL))M
Pulse duration, SPICLK low
(clock polarity = 1)
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M
0.5tc(SPC)M – 0.5tc (LCO) – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M – 0.5tc(LCO
tw(SPCL)M
Pulse duration, SPICLK low
(clock polarity = 0)
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M
0.5tc(SPC)M + 0.5tc(LCO) – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M + 0.5tc(LCO)
tw(SPCH)M
Pulse duration, SPICLK high
(clock polarity = 1)
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M
0.5tc(SPC)M + 0.5tc(LCO) – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M + 0.5tc(LCO)
tsu(SIMO-SPCH)M
Setup time, SPISIMO data valid
before SPICLK high
(clock polarity = 0)
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
tsu(SIMO-SPCL)M
Setup time, SPISIMO data valid
before SPICLK low
(clock polarity = 1)
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
tv(SPCH-SIMO)M
Valid time, SPISIMO data valid after
SPICLK high (clock polarity = 0)
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
tv(SPCL-SIMO)M
Valid time, SPISIMO data valid after
SPICLK low (clock polarity = 1)
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
tsu(SOMI-SPCH)M
Setup time, SPISOMI before
SPICLK high (clock polarity = 0)
26
26
tsu(SOMI-SPCL)M
Setup time, SPISOMI before
SPICLK low (clock polarity = 1)
26
26
tv(SPCH-SOMI)M
Valid time, SPISOMI data valid after
SPICLK high (clock polarity = 0)
0.25tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
tv(SPCL-SOMI)M
Valid time, SPISOMI data valid after
SPICLK low (clock polarity = 1)
0.25tc(SPC)M – 10
0.5tc(SPC)M – 10
3
6
7
10
11
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
132
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
The MASTER/SLAVE bit (SPICTL.2) is set and the CLOCK PHASE bit (SPICTL.3) is set.
tc(SPC) = SPI clock cycle time = LSPCLK/4 or LSPCLK/(SPIBRR + 1)
Internal clock prescalers must be adjusted such that the SPI clock speed is limited to the following SPI clock rate:
Master mode transmit 15-MHz MAX, master mode receive 10-MHz MAX
Slave mode transmit 10-MHz MAX, slave mode receive 10-MHz MAX.
tc(LCO) = LSPCLK cycle time
The active edge of the SPICLK signal referenced is controlled by the CLOCK POLARITY bit (SPICCR.6).
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
1
SPICLK
(clock polarity = 0)
2
3
SPICLK
(clock polarity = 1)
6
7
SPISIMO
Master out data Is valid
Data Valid
10
11
SPISOMI
Master in data
must be valid
SPISTE(A)
A.
In the master mode, SPISTE goes active 0.5tc(SPC) (minimum) before valid SPI clock edge. On the trailing end of the word, the SPISTE will go inactive 0.5tc(SPC) after
the receiving edge (SPICLK) of the last data bit, except that SPISTE stays active between back-to-back transmit words in both FIFO and non-FIFO modes.
Figure 6-22. SPI Master Mode External Timing (Clock Phase = 1)
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Electrical Specifications
133
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
6.11.11 SPI Slave Mode Timing
Table 6-34 lists the slave mode external timing (clock phase = 0) and Table 6-35 (clock phase = 1).
Figure 6-23 and Figure 6-24 show the timing waveforms.
Table 6-34. SPI Slave Mode External Timing (Clock Phase = 0) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5)
NO.
MIN
MAX
12
tc(SPC)S
Cycle time, SPICLK
13
tw(SPCH)S
Pulse duration, SPICLK high (clock polarity = 0)
0.5tc(SPC)S – 10
0.5tc(SPC)S
tw(SPCL)S
Pulse duration, SPICLK low (clock polarity = 1)
0.5tc(SPC)S – 10
0.5tc(SPC)S
tw(SPCL)S
Pulse duration, SPICLK low (clock polarity = 0)
0.5tc(SPC)S – 10
0.5tc(SPC)S
tw(SPCH)S
Pulse duration, SPICLK high (clock polarity = 1)
0.5tc(SPC)S – 10
0.5tc(SPC)S
td(SPCH-SOMI)S
Delay time, SPICLK high to SPISOMI valid (clock polarity = 0)
21
td(SPCL-SOMI)S
Delay time, SPICLK low to SPISOMI valid (clock polarity = 1)
21
tv(SPCL-SOMI)S
Valid time, SPISOMI data valid after SPICLK low (clock polarity = 0)
0.75tc(SPC)S
tv(SPCH-SOMI)S
Valid time, SPISOMI data valid after SPICLK high (clock polarity = 1)
0.75tc(SPC)S
tsu(SIMO-SPCL)S
Setup time, SPISIMO before SPICLK low (clock polarity = 0)
26
tsu(SIMO-SPCH)S
Setup time, SPISIMO before SPICLK high (clock polarity = 1)
26
tv(SPCL-SIMO)S
Valid time, SPISIMO data valid after SPICLK low (clock polarity = 0)
0.5tc(SPC)S – 10
tv(SPCH-SIMO)S
Valid time, SPISIMO data valid after SPICLK high (clock polarity = 1)
0.5tc(SPC)S – 10
14
15
16
19
20
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
4tc(LCO)
UNIT
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
The MASTER / SLAVE bit (SPICTL.2) is cleared and the CLOCK PHASE bit (SPICTL.3) is cleared.
tc(SPC) = SPI clock cycle time = LSPCLK/4 or LSPCLK/(SPIBRR + 1)
Internal clock prescalers must be adjusted such that the SPI clock speed is limited to the following SPI clock rate:
Master mode transmit 15-MHz MAX, master mode receive 10-MHz MAX
Slave mode transmit 10-MHz MAX, slave mode receive 10-MHz MAX.
tc(LCO) = LSPCLK cycle time
The active edge of the SPICLK signal referenced is controlled by the CLOCK POLARITY bit (SPICCR.6).
12
SPICLK
(clock polarity = 0)
13
14
SPICLK
(clock polarity = 1)
15
16
SPISOMI
SPISOMI data Is valid
19
20
SPISIMO
SPISIMO data
must be valid
SPISTE(A)
A.
In the slave mode, the SPISTE signal should be asserted low at least 0.5tc(SPC) (minimum) before the valid SPI clock
edge and remain low for at least 0.5tc(SPC) after the receiving edge (SPICLK) of the last data bit.
Figure 6-23. SPI Slave Mode External Timing (Clock Phase = 0)
134
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Table 6-35. SPI Slave Mode External Timing (Clock Phase = 1) (1) (2) (3) (4)
NO.
MIN
MAX
12
tc(SPC)S
Cycle time, SPICLK
13
tw(SPCH)S
Pulse duration, SPICLK high (clock polarity = 0)
0.5tc(SPC)S – 10
0.5tc(SPC)S
tw(SPCL)S
Pulse duration, SPICLK low (clock polarity = 1)
0.5tc(SPC)S – 10
0.5tc(SPC) S
tw(SPCL)S
Pulse duration, SPICLK low (clock polarity = 0)
0.5tc(SPC)S – 10
0.5tc(SPC) S
tw(SPCH)S
Pulse duration, SPICLK high (clock polarity = 1)
0.5tc(SPC)S – 10
0.5tc(SPC)S
tsu(SOMI-SPCH)S
Setup time, SPISOMI before SPICLK high (clock polarity = 0)
0.125tc(SPC)S
tsu(SOMI-SPCL)S
Setup time, SPISOMI before SPICLK low (clock polarity = 1)
0.125tc(SPC)S
tv(SPCL-SOMI)S
Valid time, SPISOMI data valid after SPICLK low
(clock polarity = 1)
0.75tc(SPC)S
tv(SPCH-SOMI)S
Valid time, SPISOMI data valid after SPICLK high
(clock polarity = 0)
0.75tc(SPC) S
tsu(SIMO-SPCH)S
Setup time, SPISIMO before SPICLK high (clock polarity = 0)
26
tsu(SIMO-SPCL)S
Setup time, SPISIMO before SPICLK low (clock polarity = 1)
26
tv(SPCH-SIMO)S
Valid time, SPISIMO data valid after SPICLK high
(clock polarity = 0)
0.5tc(SPC)S – 10
tv(SPCL-SIMO)S
Valid time, SPISIMO data valid after SPICLK low
(clock polarity = 1)
0.5tc(SPC)S – 10
14
17
18
21
22
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
8tc(LCO)
UNIT
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
The MASTER / SLAVE bit (SPICTL.2) is cleared and the CLOCK PHASE bit (SPICTL.3) is cleared.
tc(SPC) = SPI clock cycle time = LSPCLK/4 or LSPCLK/(SPIBRR + 1)
Internal clock prescalers must be adjusted such that the SPI clock speed is limited to the following SPI clock rate:
Master mode transmit 15-MHz MAX, master mode receive 10-MHz MAX
Slave mode transmit 10-MHz MAX, slave mode receive 10-MHz MAX.
The active edge of the SPICLK signal referenced is controlled by the CLOCK POLARITY bit (SPICCR.6).
12
SPICLK
(clock polarity = 0)
13
14
SPICLK
(clock polarity = 1)
17
18
SPISOMI
SPISOMI data is valid
Data Valid
21
22
SPISIMO
SPISIMO data
must be valid
SPISTE(A)
A.
In the slave mode, the SPISTE signal should be asserted low at least 0.5tc(SPC) before the valid SPI clock edge and
remain low for at least 0.5tc(SPC) after the receiving edge (SPICLK) of the last data bit.
Figure 6-24. SPI Slave Mode External Timing (Clock Phase = 1)
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
135
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
6.11.12 On-Chip Comparator/DAC
Table 6-36. Electrical Characteristics of the Comparator/DAC
CHARACTERISTIC
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
Comparator
Comparator Input Range
VSSA – VDDA
V
Comparator response time to PWM Trip Zone (Async)
30
ns
Input Offset
±5
mV
35
mV
Input Hysteresis
(1)
DAC
DAC Output Range
VSSA – VDDA
DAC resolution
10
DAC settling time
bits
See Figure 625
DAC Gain
DAC Offset
Monotonic
–1.5
%
10
mV
Yes
INL
(1)
V
±3
LSB
Hysteresis on the comparator inputs is achieved with a Schmidt trigger configuration. This results in an effective 100-kΩ feedback
resistance between the output of the comparator and the non-inverting input of the comparator. There is an option to disable the
hysteresis and, with it, the feedback resistance; see the TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) and
Comparator Reference Guide (literature number SPRUGE5) for more information on this option if needed in your system.
1100
1000
900
800
Settling Time (ns)
700
600
500
400
300
200
100
0
0
50
100
150
200
250
300
350
400
450
500
DAC Step Size (Codes)
DAC Accuracy
15 Codes
7 Codes
3 Codes
1 Code
Figure 6-25. DAC Settling Time
136
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
6.11.13 On-Chip Analog-to-Digital Converter
Table 6-37. ADC Electrical Characteristics
PARAMETER
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNIT
DC SPECIFICATIONS
Resolution
12
Bits
ADC clock
60-MHz device
0.001
60
MHz
Sample Window
28035/34/33/32
7
64
24
64
ADC
Clocks
INL (Integral nonlinearity) at ADC Clock ≤ 30 MHz (1)
–4
4
LSB
DNL (Differential nonlinearity) at ADC Clock ≤ 30 MHz,
no missing codes
–1
1
LSB
LSB
28031/30
ACCURACY
Offset error
(2)
Executing a single selfrecalibration (3)
–20
0
20
Executing periodic selfrecalibration (4)
–4
0
4
Overall gain error with internal reference
–60
60
LSB
Overall gain error with external reference
–40
40
LSB
Channel-to-channel offset variation
–4
4
LSB
Channel-to-channel gain variation
–4
4
LSB
ADC temperature coefficient with internal reference
–50
ppm/°C
ADC temperature coefficient with external reference
–20
ppm/°C
VREFLO
–100
µA
VREFHI
100
µA
ANALOG INPUT
Analog input voltage with internal reference
0
3.3
V
Analog input voltage with external reference
VREFLO
VREFHI
V
VSSA
0.66
V
2.64
VDDA
V
1.98
VDDA
VREFLO input voltage
(5)
VREFHI input voltage (6)
with VREFLO = VSSA
Input capacitance
Input leakage current
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
5
pF
±2
μA
INL will degrade when the ADC input voltage goes above VDDA.
1 LSB has the weighted value of full-scale range (FSR)/4096. FSR is 3.3 V with internal reference and VREFHI - VREFLO for external
reference.
For more details, see the TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032, TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
Piccolo MCU Silicon Errata (literature number SPRZ295).
Periodic self-recalibration will remove system-level and temperature dependencies on the ADC zero offset error. This can be performed
as needed in the application without sacrificing an ADC channel by using the procedure listed in the "ADC Zero Offset Calibration"
section of the TMS320x2802x, 2803x Piccolo Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) and Comparator Reference Guide (literature number
SPRUGE5).
VREFLO is always connected to VSSA on the 64-pin PAG device.
VREFHI must not exceed VDDA when using either internal or external reference modes. Since VREFHI is tied to ADCINA0 on the 64-pin
PAG device, the input signal on ADCINA0 must not exceed VDDA.
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
137
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Table 6-38. ADC Power Modes
IDDA
UNITS
Mode A – Operating Mode
ADC OPERATING MODE
ADC Clock Enabled
Bandgap On (ADCBGPWD = 1)
Reference On (ADCREFPWD = 1)
ADC Powered Up (ADCPWDN = 1)
CONDITIONS
13
mA
Mode B – Quick Wake Mode
ADC Clock Enabled
Bandgap On (ADCBGPWD = 1)
Reference On (ADCREFPWD = 1)
ADC Powered Up (ADCPWDN = 0)
4
mA
Mode C – Comparator-Only Mode
ADC Clock Enabled
Bandgap On (ADCBGPWD = 1)
Reference On (ADCREFPWD = 0)
ADC Powered Up (ADCPWDN = 0)
1.5
mA
Mode D – Off Mode
ADC Clock Enabled
Bandgap On (ADCBGPWD = 0)
Reference On (ADCREFPWD = 0)
ADC Powered Up (ADCPWDN = 0)
0.075
mA
6.11.13.1 Internal Temperature Sensor
Table 6-39. Temperature Sensor Coefficient
PARAMETER (1)
MIN
TSLOPE
Degrees C of temperature movement per measured ADC LSB change
of the temperature sensor
TOFFSET
ADC output at 0°C of the temperature sensor
(1)
(2)
(3)
TYP
MAX
0.18 (2) (3)
UNIT
°C/LSB
1750
LSB
The temperature sensor slope and offset are given in terms of ADC LSBs using the internal reference of the ADC. Values must be
adjusted accordingly in external reference mode to the external reference voltage.
ADC temperature coeffieicient is accounted for in this specification
Output of the temperature sensor (in terms of LSBs) is sign-consistent with the direction of the temperature movement. Increasing
temperatures will give increasing ADC values relative to an initial value; decreasing temperatures will give decreasing ADC values
relative to an initial value.
6.11.13.2 ADC Power-Up Control Bit Timing
Table 6-40. ADC Power-Up Delays
PARAMETER (1)
td(PWD)
(1)
MIN
TYP
MAX
Delay time for the ADC to be stable after power up
1
UNIT
ms
Timings maintain compatibility to the ADC module. The 2803x ADC supports driving all 3 bits at the same time td(PWD) ms before first
conversion.
ADCPWDN/
ADCBGPWD/
ADCREFPWD/
ADCENABLE
td(PWD)
Request for ADC
Conversion
Figure 6-26. ADC Conversion Timing
138
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
ADCIN
Rs
Source
Signal
Ron
3.4 kW
Switch
Cp
5 pF
ac
Ch
1.6 pF
28x DSP
Typical Values of the Input Circuit Components:
Switch Resistance (Ron): 3.4 k W
Sampling Capacitor (Ch): 1.6 pF
Parasitic Capacitance (Cp): 5 pF
Source Resistance (Rs): 50 W
Figure 6-27. ADC Input Impedance Model
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
139
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
6.11.13.3 ADC Sequential and Simultaneous Timings
Analog Input
SOC0 Sample
Window
0
2
SOC1 Sample
Window
9
15
SOC2 Sample
Window
22
24
37
ADCCLK
ADCCTL 1.INTPULSEPOS
ADCSOCFLG 1.SOC0
ADCSOCFLG 1.SOC1
ADCSOCFLG 1.SOC2
S/H Window Pulse to Core
SOC0
ADCRESULT 0
SOC1
2 ADCCLKs
SOC2
Result 0 Latched
ADCRESULT 1
EOC0 Pulse
EOC1 Pulse
ADCINTFLG .ADCINTx
Minimum
7 ADCCLKs
Conversion 0
13 ADC Clocks
6
ADCCLKs
Minimum
7 ADCCLKs
1 ADCCLK
Conversion 1
13 ADC Clocks
Figure 6-28. Timing Example for Sequential Mode / Late Interrupt Pulse
140
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Analog Input
SOC0 Sample
Window
0
2
SOC1 Sample
Window
9
15
SOC2 Sample
Window
22
24
37
ADCCLK
ADCCTL1.INTPULSEPOS
ADCSOCFLG 1.SOC0
ADCSOCFLG 1.SOC1
ADCSOCFLG 1.SOC2
S/H Window Pulse to Core
SOC0
SOC1
SOC2
Result 0 Latched
ADCRESULT 0
ADCRESULT 1
EOC0 Pulse
EOC1 Pulse
EOC2 Pulse
ADCINTFLG .ADCINTx
Minimum
7 ADCCLKs
Conversion 0
13 ADC Clocks
6
ADCCLKs
Minimum
7 ADCCLKs
2 ADCCLKs
Conversion 1
13 ADC Clocks
Figure 6-29. Timing Example for Sequential Mode / Early Interrupt Pulse
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
141
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Analog Input A
SOC0 Sample
A Window
SOC2 Sample
A Window
SOC0 Sample
B Window
SOC2 Sample
B Window
Analog Input B
0
2
9
22
24
37
50
ADCCLK
ADCCTL1.INTPULSEPOS
ADCSOCFLG 1.SOC0
ADCSOCFLG 1.SOC1
ADCSOCFLG 1.SOC2
S/H Window Pulse to Core
SOC0 (A/B)
ADCRESULT 0
SOC2 (A/B)
2 ADCCLKs
Result 0 (A) Latched
ADCRESULT 1
Result 0 (B) Latched
ADCRESULT 2
EOC0 Pulse
1 ADCCLK
EOC1 Pulse
EOC2 Pulse
ADCINTFLG .ADCINTx
Minimum
7 ADCCLKs
Conversion 0 (A)
13 ADC Clocks
19
ADCCLKs
Conversion 0 (B)
13 ADC Clocks
Minimum
7 ADCCLKs
2 ADCCLKs
Conversion 1 (A)
13 ADC Clocks
Figure 6-30. Timing Example for Simultaneous Mode / Late Interrupt Pulse
142
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
Analog Input A
SOC0 Sample
A Window
SOC2 Sample
A Window
SOC0 Sample
B Window
SOC2 Sample
B Window
Analog Input B
0
9
2
22 24
37
50
ADCCLK
ADCCTL1.INTPULSEPOS
ADCSOCFLG1.SOC0
ADCSOCFLG1.SOC1
ADCSOCFLG1.SOC2
S/H Window Pulse to Core
SOC0 (A/B)
SOC2 (A/B)
2 ADCCLKs
ADCRESULT 0
Result 0 (A) Latched
Result 0 (B) Latched
ADCRESULT 1
ADCRESULT 2
EOC0 Pulse
EOC1 Pulse
EOC2 Pulse
ADCINTFLG.ADCINTx
Minimum
7 ADCCLKs
Conversion 0 (A)
13 ADC Clocks
19
ADCCLKs
Conversion 0 (B)
13 ADC Clocks
Minimum
7 ADCCLKs
2 ADCCLKs
Conversion 1 (A)
13 ADC Clocks
Figure 6-31. Timing Example for Simultaneous Mode / Early Interrupt Pulse
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
143
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
6.12 Detailed Descriptions
Integral Nonlinearity
Integral nonlinearity refers to the deviation of each individual code from a line drawn from zero through full
scale. The point used as zero occurs one-half LSB before the first code transition. The full-scale point is
defined as level one-half LSB beyond the last code transition. The deviation is measured from the center
of each particular code to the true straight line between these two points.
Differential Nonlinearity
An ideal ADC exhibits code transitions that are exactly 1 LSB apart. DNL is the deviation from this ideal
value. A differential nonlinearity error of less than ±1 LSB ensures no missing codes.
Zero Offset
The major carry transition should occur when the analog input is at zero volts. Zero error is defined as the
deviation of the actual transition from that point.
Gain Error
The first code transition should occur at an analog value one-half LSB above negative full scale. The last
transition should occur at an analog value one and one-half LSB below the nominal full scale. Gain error is
the deviation of the actual difference between first and last code transitions and the ideal difference
between first and last code transitions.
Signal-to-Noise Ratio + Distortion (SINAD)
SINAD is the ratio of the rms value of the measured input signal to the rms sum of all other spectral
components below the Nyquist frequency, including harmonics but excluding dc. The value for SINAD is
expressed in decibels.
Effective Number of Bits (ENOB)
For a sine wave, SINAD can be expressed in terms of the number of bits. Using the following formula,
(SINAD - 1.76)
N=
6.02
it is possible to get a measure of performance expressed as N, the effective number of
bits. Thus, effective number of bits for a device for sine wave inputs at a given input frequency can be
calculated directly from its measured SINAD.
Total Harmonic Distortion (THD)
THD is the ratio of the rms sum of the first nine harmonic components to the rms value of the measured
input signal and is expressed as a percentage or in decibels.
Spurious Free Dynamic Range (SFDR)
SFDR is the difference in dB between the rms amplitude of the input signal and the peak spurious signal.
144
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
6.13 Flash Timing
Table 6-41. Flash/OTP Endurance for T Temperature Material (1)
ERASE/PROGRAM
TEMPERATURE
Nf
Flash endurance for the array (write/erase cycles)
0°C to 105°C (ambient)
NOTP
OTP endurance for the array (write cycles)
0°C to 30°C (ambient)
(1)
MIN
TYP
20000
50000
MAX
UNIT
cycles
1
write
Write/erase operations outside of the temperature ranges indicated are not specified and may affect the endurance numbers.
Table 6-42. Flash/OTP Endurance for S Temperature Material (1)
ERASE/PROGRAM
TEMPERATURE
Nf
NOTP
(1)
Flash endurance for the array (write/erase cycles)
0°C to 125°C (ambient)
OTP endurance for the array (write cycles)
0°C to 30°C (ambient)
MIN
TYP
20000
50000
MAX
UNIT
cycles
1
write
Write/erase operations outside of the temperature ranges indicated are not specified and may affect the endurance numbers.
Table 6-43. Flash/OTP Endurance for Q Temperature Material (1)
ERASE/PROGRAM
TEMPERATURE
Nf
Flash endurance for the array (write/erase cycles)
–40°C to 125°C (ambient)
NOTP
OTP endurance for the array (write cycles)
–40°C to 30°C (ambient)
(1)
MIN
TYP
20000
50000
MAX
UNIT
cycles
1
write
Write/erase operations outside of the temperature ranges indicated are not specified and may affect the endurance numbers.
Table 6-44. Flash Parameters at 60-MHz SYSCLKOUT
TEST
CONDITIONS
PARAMETER
Program Time
Erase Time (1)
(2)
UNIT
8K Sector
250
ms
4K Sector
125
ms
8K Sector
2
VDD current consumption during Erase/Program cycle
(2)
VDDIO current consumption during Erase/Program cycle
IDDIOP
(2)
VDDIO current consumption during Erase/Program cycle
(2)
MAX
μs
IDDIOP
(1)
TYP
50
16-Bit Word
4K Sector
IDDP
MIN
VREG
disabled
VREG enabled
s
2
s
80
mA
60
120
mA
The on-chip flash memory is in an erased state when the device is shipped from TI. As such, erasing the flash memory is not required
prior to programming, when programming the device for the first time. However, the erase operation is needed on all subsequent
programming operations.
Typical parameters as seen at room temperature including function call overhead, with all peripherals off. It is important to maintain a
stable power supply during the entire flash programming process. It is conceivable that device current consumption during flash
programming could be higher than normal operating conditions. The power supply used should ensure VMIN on the supply rails at all
times, as specified in the Recommended Operating Conditions of the data sheet. Any brown-out or interruption to power during
erasing/programming could potentially corrupt the password locations and lock the device permanently. Powering a target board (during
flash programming) through the USB port is not recommended, as the port may be unable to respond to the power demands placed
during the programming process.
Table 6-45. Flash/OTP Access Timing
PARAMETER
MIN
MAX
UNIT
ta(fp)
Paged Flash access time
40
ns
ta(fr)
Random Flash access time
40
ns
ta(OTP)
OTP access time
60
ns
Electrical Specifications
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
145
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
www.ti.com
Table 6-46. Flash Data Retention Duration
PARAMETER
tretention
TEST CONDITIONS
Data retention duration
TJ = 55°C
MIN
MAX
15
UNIT
years
Table 6-47. Minimum Required Flash/OTP Wait-States at Different Frequencies
(1)
SYSCLKOUT
(MHz)
SYSCLKOUT
(ns)
PAGE
WAIT-STATE (1)
RANDOM
WAIT-STATE (1)
OTP
WAIT-STATE
60
16.67
2
2
3
55
18.18
2
2
3
50
20
1
1
2
45
22.22
1
1
2
40
25
1
1
2
35
28.57
1
1
2
30
33.33
1
1
1
25
40
0
1
1
Random wait-state must be ≥ 1.
The equations to compute the Flash page wait-state and random wait-state in Table 6-47 are as follows:
ù
éæ t a( f · p ) ö
÷ - 1ú round up to the next highest integer
Flash Page Wait State = êç
úû
êëçè t c (SCO ) ÷ø
éæ t a(f ×r) ö ù
÷ - 1ú round up to the next highest integer, or 1, whichever is larger
Flash Random Wait State = êç
êëçè t c(SCO) ÷ø úû
The equation to compute the OTP wait-state in Table 6-47 is as follows:
éæ t a(OTP) ö ù
÷ - 1ú round up to the next highest integer, or 1, whichever is larger
OTP Wait State = êç
êëçè t c(SCO) ÷ø úû
146
Electrical Specifications
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
TMS320F28030, TMS320F28031, TMS320F28032
TMS320F28033, TMS320F28034, TMS320F28035
www.ti.com
SPRS584J – APRIL 2009 – REVISED OCTOBER 2013
7 Thermal/Mechanical Data
Table 7-1, Table 7-2, and Table 7-3 show the thermal data. See Section 6.5 for more information on
thermal design considerations.
The mechanical package diagrams that follow the tables reflect the most current released mechanical data
available for the designated devices.
Table 7-1. Thermal Model 56-Pin RSH Results
AIR FLOW
PARAMETER
0 lfm
150 lfm
250 lfm
500 lfm
θJA [°C/W] High k PCB
34.8
23.6
22.3
20.5
ΨJT [°C/W]
0.24
0.36
0.43
0.56
ΨJB
9.2
8.8
8.9
8.8
θJC
14.7
θJB
9.2
Table 7-2. Thermal Model 64-Pin PAG Results
AIR FLOW
PARAMETER
0 lfm
150 lfm
250 lfm
500 lfm
θJA [°C/W] High k PCB
56.5
44.7
42.9
40.3
ΨJT [°C/W]
0.15
0.42
0.51
0.67
ΨJB
31.1
29.7
29.2
28.4
θJC
7.6
θJB
31.3
Table 7-3. Thermal Model 80-Pin PN Results
AIR FLOW
PARAMETER
0 lfm
150 lfm
250 lfm
500 lfm
θJA [°C/W] High k PCB
49.9
38.3
36.7
34.4
ΨJT [°C/W]
0.8
1.18
1.34
1.62
ΨJB
21.6
20.7
20.5
20.1
θJC
14.2
θJB
21.9
Thermal/Mechanical Data
Submit Documentation Feedback
Product Folder Links: TMS320F28030 TMS320F28031 TMS320F28032 TMS320F28033 TMS320F28034
TMS320F28035
Copyright © 2009–2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated
147
MECHANICAL DATA
MTQF006A – JANUARY 1995 – REVISED DECEMBER 1996
PAG (S-PQFP-G64)
PLASTIC QUAD FLATPACK
0,27
0,17
0,50
48
0,08 M
33
49
32
64
17
0,13 NOM
1
16
7,50 TYP
Gage Plane
10,20
SQ
9,80
12,20
SQ
11,80
0,25
0,05 MIN
1,05
0,95
0°– 7°
0,75
0,45
Seating Plane
0,08
1,20 MAX
4040282 / C 11/96
NOTES: A. All linear dimensions are in millimeters.
B. This drawing is subject to change without notice.
C. Falls within JEDEC MS-026
POST OFFICE BOX 655303
• DALLAS, TEXAS 75265
MECHANICAL DATA
MTQF010A – JANUARY 1995 – REVISED DECEMBER 1996
PN (S-PQFP-G80)
PLASTIC QUAD FLATPACK
0,27
0,17
0,50
0,08 M
41
60
61
40
80
21
0,13 NOM
1
20
Gage Plane
9,50 TYP
12,20
SQ
11,80
14,20
SQ
13,80
0,25
0,05 MIN
0°– 7°
0,75
0,45
1,45
1,35
Seating Plane
0,08
1,60 MAX
4040135 / B 11/96
NOTES: A. All linear dimensions are in millimeters.
B. This drawing is subject to change without notice.
C. Falls within JEDEC MS-026
POST OFFICE BOX 655303
• DALLAS, TEXAS 75265
1
PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM
www.ti.com
10-Mar-2016
PACKAGING INFORMATION
Orderable Device
Status
(1)
Package Type Package Pins Package
Drawing
Qty
Eco Plan
Lead/Ball Finish
MSL Peak Temp
(2)
(6)
(3)
Op Temp (°C)
Device Marking
(4/5)
TMS320F28030PAGQ
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28030PAGQ
TMS320
TMS320F28030PAGS
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28030PAGS
TMS320
TMS320F28030PAGT
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28030PAGT
TMS320
TMS320F28030PNQ
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28030PNQ
TMS320
TMS320F28030PNS
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28030PNS
TMS320
TMS320F28030PNT
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28030PNT
TMS320
TMS320F28030RSHS
ACTIVE
VQFN
RSH
56
260
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28030RSHS
S320
TMS320F28030RSHT
ACTIVE
VQFN
RSH
56
260
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28030RSHT
S320
TMS320F28031PAGQ
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28031PAGQ
TMS320
TMS320F28031PAGS
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28031PAGS
TMS320
TMS320F28031PAGT
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28031PAGT
TMS320
TMS320F28031PNQ
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28031PNQ
TMS320
TMS320F28031PNS
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28031PNS
TMS320
TMS320F28031PNT
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28031PNT
TMS320
TMS320F28031RSHS
ACTIVE
VQFN
RSH
56
260
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28031RSHS
S320
TMS320F28031RSHT
ACTIVE
VQFN
RSH
56
260
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28031RSHT
S320
TMS320F28032PAGQ
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28032PAGQ
TMS320
Addendum-Page 1
Samples
PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM
www.ti.com
Orderable Device
10-Mar-2016
Status
(1)
Package Type Package Pins Package
Drawing
Qty
Eco Plan
Lead/Ball Finish
MSL Peak Temp
(2)
(6)
(3)
Op Temp (°C)
Device Marking
(4/5)
TMS320F28032PAGS
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28032PAGS
TMS320
TMS320F28032PAGT
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28032PAGT
TMS320
TMS320F28032PNQ
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28032PNQ
TMS320
TMS320F28032PNS
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28032PNS
TMS320
TMS320F28032PNT
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28032PNT
TMS320
TMS320F28032RSHS
ACTIVE
VQFN
RSH
56
260
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28032RSHS
S320
TMS320F28032RSHT
ACTIVE
VQFN
RSH
56
260
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28032RSHT
S320
TMS320F28033PAGQ
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28033PAGQ
TMS320
TMS320F28033PAGS
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28033PAGS
TMS320
TMS320F28033PAGT
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28033PAGT
TMS320
TMS320F28033PNQ
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28033PNQ
TMS320
TMS320F28033PNS
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28033PNS
TMS320
TMS320F28033PNT
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28033PNT
TMS320
TMS320F28033RSHS
ACTIVE
VQFN
RSH
56
260
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28033RSHS
S320
TMS320F28033RSHT
ACTIVE
VQFN
RSH
56
260
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28033RSHT
S320
TMS320F28034PAGQ
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28034PAGQ
TMS320
TMS320F28034PAGS
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28034PAGS
TMS320
TMS320F28034PAGT
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28034PAGT
TMS320
Addendum-Page 2
Samples
PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM
www.ti.com
Orderable Device
10-Mar-2016
Status
(1)
Package Type Package Pins Package
Drawing
Qty
Eco Plan
Lead/Ball Finish
MSL Peak Temp
(2)
(6)
(3)
Op Temp (°C)
Device Marking
(4/5)
TMS320F28034PNQ
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28034PNQ
TMS320
TMS320F28034PNS
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28034PNS
TMS320
TMS320F28034PNT
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28034PNT
TMS320
TMS320F28034RSHS
ACTIVE
VQFN
RSH
56
260
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28034RSHS
S320
TMS320F28034RSHT
ACTIVE
VQFN
RSH
56
260
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28034RSHT
S320
TMS320F28035PAGQ
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28035PAGQ
TMS320
TMS320F28035PAGS
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28035PAGS
TMS320
TMS320F28035PAGT
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
160
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28035PAGT
TMS320
TMS320F28035PAGTR
ACTIVE
TQFP
PAG
64
1500
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28035PAGT
TMS320
TMS320F28035PNQ
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28035PNQ
TMS320
TMS320F28035PNQR
PREVIEW
LQFP
PN
80
1000
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28035PNQ
TMS320
TMS320F28035PNS
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28035PNS
TMS320
TMS320F28035PNT
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28035PNT
TMS320
TMS320F28035RSHS
ACTIVE
VQFN
RSH
56
260
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28035RSHS
S320
TMS320F28035RSHT
ACTIVE
VQFN
RSH
56
260
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 105
F28035RSHT
S320
TMS32F28032LENAPNS
ACTIVE
LQFP
PN
80
119
Green (RoHS
& no Sb/Br)
CU NIPDAU
Level-3-260C-168 HR
-40 to 125
F28032PNS
TMS320
(1)
The marketing status values are defined as follows:
ACTIVE: Product device recommended for new designs.
LIFEBUY: TI has announced that the device will be discontinued, and a lifetime-buy period is in effect.
NRND: Not recommended for new designs. Device is in production to support existing customers, but TI does not recommend using this part in a new design.
Addendum-Page 3
Samples
PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM
www.ti.com
10-Mar-2016
PREVIEW: Device has been announced but is not in production. Samples may or may not be available.
OBSOLETE: TI has discontinued the production of the device.
(2)
Eco Plan - The planned eco-friendly classification: Pb-Free (RoHS), Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt), or Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) - please check http://www.ti.com/productcontent for the latest availability
information and additional product content details.
TBD: The Pb-Free/Green conversion plan has not been defined.
Pb-Free (RoHS): TI's terms "Lead-Free" or "Pb-Free" mean semiconductor products that are compatible with the current RoHS requirements for all 6 substances, including the requirement that
lead not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous materials. Where designed to be soldered at high temperatures, TI Pb-Free products are suitable for use in specified lead-free processes.
Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt): This component has a RoHS exemption for either 1) lead-based flip-chip solder bumps used between the die and package, or 2) lead-based die adhesive used between
the die and leadframe. The component is otherwise considered Pb-Free (RoHS compatible) as defined above.
Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br): TI defines "Green" to mean Pb-Free (RoHS compatible), and free of Bromine (Br) and Antimony (Sb) based flame retardants (Br or Sb do not exceed 0.1% by weight
in homogeneous material)
(3)
MSL, Peak Temp. - The Moisture Sensitivity Level rating according to the JEDEC industry standard classifications, and peak solder temperature.
(4)
There may be additional marking, which relates to the logo, the lot trace code information, or the environmental category on the device.
(5)
Multiple Device Markings will be inside parentheses. Only one Device Marking contained in parentheses and separated by a "~" will appear on a device. If a line is indented then it is a continuation
of the previous line and the two combined represent the entire Device Marking for that device.
(6)
Lead/Ball Finish - Orderable Devices may have multiple material finish options. Finish options are separated by a vertical ruled line. Lead/Ball Finish values may wrap to two lines if the finish
value exceeds the maximum column width.
Important Information and Disclaimer:The information provided on this page represents TI's knowledge and belief as of the date that it is provided. TI bases its knowledge and belief on information
provided by third parties, and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such information. Efforts are underway to better integrate information from third parties. TI has taken and
continues to take reasonable steps to provide representative and accurate information but may not have conducted destructive testing or chemical analysis on incoming materials and chemicals.
TI and TI suppliers consider certain information to be proprietary, and thus CAS numbers and other limited information may not be available for release.
In no event shall TI's liability arising out of such information exceed the total purchase price of the TI part(s) at issue in this document sold by TI to Customer on an annual basis.
Addendum-Page 4
IMPORTANT NOTICE
Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other
changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest
issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and
complete. All semiconductor products (also referred to herein as “components”) are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale
supplied at the time of order acknowledgment.
TI warrants performance of its components to the specifications applicable at the time of sale, in accordance with the warranty in TI’s terms
and conditions of sale of semiconductor products. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary
to support this warranty. Except where mandated by applicable law, testing of all parameters of each component is not necessarily
performed.
TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or the design of Buyers’ products. Buyers are responsible for their products and
applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with Buyers’ products and applications, Buyers should provide
adequate design and operating safeguards.
TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or
other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI components or services are used. Information
published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services or a warranty or
endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the
third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI.
Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration
and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered
documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions.
Resale of TI components or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that component or service
voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI component or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice.
TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements.
Buyer acknowledges and agrees that it is solely responsible for compliance with all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements
concerning its products, and any use of TI components in its applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support
that may be provided by TI. Buyer represents and agrees that it has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards which
anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, monitor failures and their consequences, lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause
harm and take appropriate remedial actions. Buyer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use
of any TI components in safety-critical applications.
In some cases, TI components may be promoted specifically to facilitate safety-related applications. With such components, TI’s goal is to
help enable customers to design and create their own end-product solutions that meet applicable functional safety standards and
requirements. Nonetheless, such components are subject to these terms.
No TI components are authorized for use in FDA Class III (or similar life-critical medical equipment) unless authorized officers of the parties
have executed a special agreement specifically governing such use.
Only those TI components which TI has specifically designated as military grade or “enhanced plastic” are designed and intended for use in
military/aerospace applications or environments. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that any military or aerospace use of TI components
which have not been so designated is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that Buyer is solely responsible for compliance with all legal and
regulatory requirements in connection with such use.
TI has specifically designated certain components as meeting ISO/TS16949 requirements, mainly for automotive use. In any case of use of
non-designated products, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet ISO/TS16949.
Products
Applications
Audio
www.ti.com/audio
Automotive and Transportation
www.ti.com/automotive
Amplifiers
amplifier.ti.com
Communications and Telecom
www.ti.com/communications
Data Converters
dataconverter.ti.com
Computers and Peripherals
www.ti.com/computers
DLP® Products
www.dlp.com
Consumer Electronics
www.ti.com/consumer-apps
DSP
dsp.ti.com
Energy and Lighting
www.ti.com/energy
Clocks and Timers
www.ti.com/clocks
Industrial
www.ti.com/industrial
Interface
interface.ti.com
Medical
www.ti.com/medical
Logic
logic.ti.com
Security
www.ti.com/security
Power Mgmt
power.ti.com
Space, Avionics and Defense
www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense
Microcontrollers
microcontroller.ti.com
Video and Imaging
www.ti.com/video
RFID
www.ti-rfid.com
OMAP Applications Processors
www.ti.com/omap
TI E2E Community
e2e.ti.com
Wireless Connectivity
www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity
Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265
Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated
Download PDF